Before this patch...
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110 default definition is used.
111
112 @node Driver
113 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114 @cindex driver
115 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
118 You can control the compilation driver.
119
120 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133 that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136 @end defmac
137
138 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148 everywhere it occurs.
149
150 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155 @end defmac
156
157 @defmac CPP_SPEC
158 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163 @end defmac
164
165 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CC1_SPEC
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174 front ends.
175 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176 for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179 @end defmac
180
181 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190 @end defmac
191
192 @defmac ASM_SPEC
193 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199 @end defmac
200
201 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205 an example of this.
206
207 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208 @end defmac
209
210 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221 @end defmac
222
223 @defmac LINK_SPEC
224 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229 @end defmac
230
231 @defmac LIB_SPEC
232 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234 command given to the linker.
235
236 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238 @end defmac
239
240 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248 @end defmac
249
250 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260 @end defmac
261
262 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268 @end defmac
269
270 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284 @end defmac
285
286 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289 the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302 @end defmac
303
304 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308 @end defmac
309
310 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324 string constant that provides the specification.
325
326 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331 these definitions.
332
333 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336 used.
337
338 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340 @smallexample
341 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345 @end smallexample
346
347 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348 @smallexample
349 #undef CPP_SPEC
350 #define CPP_SPEC \
351 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358 @end smallexample
359
360 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363 @smallexample
364 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366 @end smallexample
367 @end defmac
368
369 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373 @end defmac
374
375 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378 @end defmac
379
380 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388 @end defmac
389
390 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
391 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
392 @end deftypevr
393
394 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
395 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403 @xref{Target Fragment}.
404 @end defmac
405
406 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
407 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
408 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
409 indicates an absolute file name.
410 @end defmac
411
412 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
413 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
414 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
415 when the compiler is built as a cross
416 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
417 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
418 @end defmac
419
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
423 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
426 @end defmac
427
428 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
429 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
431 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
433 is built as a cross compiler.
434 @end defmac
435
436 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
437 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
438 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
439 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
440 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
441 is built as a cross compiler.
442 @end defmac
443
444 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
445 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
446 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
447 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
448 @end defmac
449
450 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
451 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
452 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
453 cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
457 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
458 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
459 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
460 initialize the necessary environment variables.
461 @end defmac
462
463 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
464 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
465 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
466 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
467 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
468 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
469
470 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
471 replacement.
472 @end defmac
473
474 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
475 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
476 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
477 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
478 @end defmac
479
480 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
481 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
482 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
483 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
484 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
485 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
486 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
487 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
488 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
489
490 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
491 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
492 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
493 for C++-only directories,
494 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
495 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
496 the array with a null element.
497
498 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
499 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
500 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
501 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
502
503 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
504
505 @smallexample
506 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
507 @{ \
508 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
509 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
511 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
513 @}
514 @end smallexample
515 @end defmac
516
517 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
518
519 @enumerate
520 @item
521 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
522
523 @item
524 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
525 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
526 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
527
528 @item
529 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
530
531 @item
532 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
533 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
534
535 @item
536 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
543 compiler.
544 @end enumerate
545
546 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
547
548 @enumerate
549 @item
550 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
551
552 @item
553 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
554 value based on the installed toolchain location.
555
556 @item
557 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
558 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
559
560 @item
561 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
562 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
563
564 @item
565 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
569 compiler.
570
571 @item
572 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
573 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
574
575 @item
576 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
577 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578
579 @item
580 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
581 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
582 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
583
584 @item
585 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
586 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
587 @file{/lib/}.
588
589 @item
590 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
591 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
592 @file{/usr/lib/}.
593 @end enumerate
594
595 @node Run-time Target
596 @section Run-time Target Specification
597 @cindex run-time target specification
598 @cindex predefined macros
599 @cindex target specifications
600
601 @c prevent bad page break with this line
602 Here are run-time target specifications.
603
604 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
605 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
606 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
607 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
608 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
609 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
610 finished command line option processing your code can use those
611 results freely.
612
613 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
614 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
615 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
616 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
617
618 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
619 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
620 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
621 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
622 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
623 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
624 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
625 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
626 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
627 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
628
629 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
630 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
631 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
632 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
633 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
634 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
635 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
636 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
637 preprocessing.
638 @end defmac
639
640 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
641 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
642 and is used for the target operating system instead.
643 @end defmac
644
645 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
646 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
647 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
648 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
649 it yourself.
650 @end defmac
651
652 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
653 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
654 any target-specific headers.
655 @end deftypevar
656
657 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
658 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
659 Its default setting is 0.
660 @end deftypevr
661
662 @cindex optional hardware or system features
663 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
664
665 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
666 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
667 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
668 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
669 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
670 definition does nothing but return true.
671
672 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
673 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
674 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
675 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
676 via attributes).
677 @end deftypefn
678
679 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
680 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
681 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
682 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
683 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
684 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
685 default definition does nothing but return false.
686
687 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
688 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
689 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
690 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
691 @end deftypefn
692
693 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
694 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
695 @end deftypefn
696
697 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
698 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
699 @end deftypefn
700
701 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
702 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
703 @end deftypefn
704
705 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
706 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
707 @end deftypefn
708
709 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
710 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
711 @end deftypefn
712
713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
714 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
715 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
716 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
717 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
718 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
719 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
720 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
721 @end deftypefn
722
723 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
724 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
725 but is only used in the C
726 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
727 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
728 frontends.
729 @end defmac
730
731 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
732 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
733 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
734 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
735 options are processed once
736 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
737 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
738 options passed explicitly.
739
740 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
741 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
742 @code{optimize} attribute.
743 @end deftypevr
744
745 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
746 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
747 @end deftypefn
748
749 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
750 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
751 @end deftypefn
752
753 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
754 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
755 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
756 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
757 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
758 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
759
760 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
761 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
762 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
763 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
764 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
765 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
766 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
767
768 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
769 is 0.
770 @end defmac
771
772 @node Per-Function Data
773 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
774 @cindex per-function data
775 @cindex data structures
776
777 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
778 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
779 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
780 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
781 when another one comes along.
782
783 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
784 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
785 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
786 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
787 to their own specific data.
788
789 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
790 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
791 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
792 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
793
794 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
795 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
796 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
797 function, for level 0.
798
799 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
800 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
801 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
802 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
803 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
804 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
805 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
806 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
807 longer supported.
808
809 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
810 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
811 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
812 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
813 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
814 @end defmac
815
816 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
817 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
818 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
819 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
820 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
821 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
822
823 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
824 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
825 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
826 @end deftypevar
827
828 @node Storage Layout
829 @section Storage Layout
830 @cindex storage layout
831
832 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
833 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
834 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
835 @xref{Run-time Target}.
836
837 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
838 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
839 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
840 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
841 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
842 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
843 macro need not be a constant.
844
845 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
846 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
847 @end defmac
848
849 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
850 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
851 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
852 @end defmac
853
854 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
855 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
856 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
857 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
858 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
859 macro need not be a constant.
860 @end defmac
861
862 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
863 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
864 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
865 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
866 the order of words in memory.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
871 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
872 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
873 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
874
875 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
876 multi-word integers.
877 @end defmac
878
879 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
880 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
881 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
882 @end defmac
883
884 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
885 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
886 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
887 @end defmac
888
889 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
890 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
891 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
892 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
893 @end defmac
894
895 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
896 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
897 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
898 @end defmac
899
900 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
901 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
902 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
903 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
904 @end defmac
905
906 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
907 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
908 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
909 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
910 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
911 @end defmac
912
913 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
914 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
915 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
916 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
917 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
918 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
919 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
920
921 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
922 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
923 @end defmac
924
925 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
926 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
927 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
928 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
929 scalar type.
930
931 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
932 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
933 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
934 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
935 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
936 counterparts.
937
938 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
939 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
940 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
941 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
942 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
943 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
944
945 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
946 @end defmac
947
948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
949 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
950 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
951 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
952 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
953 pointer} types.
954
955 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
956 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
957 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
958 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
959 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
960 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
961 the signedness may be different.
962
963 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
964
965 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
966 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
967 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
968 @end deftypefn
969
970 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
971 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
972 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
973 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
974 size of an integer.
975 @end defmac
976
977 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
978 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
979 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
980 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
981 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
982 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
983 @end defmac
984
985 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
986 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
987 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
988 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
989 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
990 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
991 @end defmac
992
993 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
994 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
995 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
996 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997 @end defmac
998
999 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1000 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1001 @end defmac
1002
1003 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1004 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1005 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1006 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1007 @end defmac
1008
1009 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1010 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1011 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1012 @end defmac
1013
1014 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1015 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1016 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1017 @end defmac
1018
1019 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1020 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1021 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1022 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1023 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1024 @end defmac
1025
1026 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1027 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1028 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1029 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1030 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1031 @end defmac
1032
1033 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1034 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1035 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1036 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1037 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1038 field alignment has not been set by the
1039 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1040 @end defmac
1041
1042 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1043 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1044 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1045
1046 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1047
1048 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1049 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1050 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1051 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1052 @end defmac
1053
1054 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1055 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1056 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1057 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1058 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1059
1060 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1061 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1062 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1063 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1064 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1065 @end defmac
1066
1067 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1068 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1069 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1070 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1071 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1072
1073 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1074
1075 @findex strcpy
1076 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1077 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1078 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1080 @end defmac
1081
1082 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1083 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1084 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1085 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1086 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1087 align the object.
1088
1089 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1090
1091 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1092 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1093 constants can be done inline.
1094 @end defmac
1095
1096 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1097 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1098 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1099 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1100 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1101
1102 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103
1104 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1105 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1106
1107 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1108 @end defmac
1109
1110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1111 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1112 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1113 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1114 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1115 the vector element type.
1116 @end deftypefn
1117
1118 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1119 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1120 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1121 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1122 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1123 align the slot.
1124
1125 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1126 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1127 be used.
1128
1129 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1130 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1131
1132 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1133 @end defmac
1134
1135 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1136 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1137 variable @var{decl}.
1138
1139 If this macro is not defined, then
1140 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1141 is used.
1142
1143 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1144 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1145
1146 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1147 @end defmac
1148
1149 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1150 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1151 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1152 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1153
1154 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1155 @end defmac
1156
1157 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1158 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1159 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1160
1161 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1162 @end defmac
1163
1164 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1165 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1166 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1167
1168 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1169 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1173 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1174 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1175 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1176 @end defmac
1177
1178 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1179 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1180 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1181
1182 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1183 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1184 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1185 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1186 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1187
1188 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1189 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1190 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1191 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1192
1193 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1194 structure.
1195
1196 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1197 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1198
1199 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1200 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1201 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1202 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1203
1204 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1205 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1206 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1207
1208 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1209 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1210 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1211
1212 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1213 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1214 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1215
1216 @smallexample
1217 struct foo1
1218 @{
1219 char x;
1220 char :0;
1221 char y;
1222 @};
1223
1224 struct foo2
1225 @{
1226 char x;
1227 int :0;
1228 char y;
1229 @};
1230
1231 main ()
1232 @{
1233 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1234 sizeof (struct foo1));
1235 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1236 sizeof (struct foo2));
1237 exit (0);
1238 @}
1239 @end smallexample
1240
1241 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1242 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1243 @end defmac
1244
1245 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1246 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1247 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1248 @end defmac
1249
1250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1251 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1252 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1253 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1254 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1255 @end deftypefn
1256
1257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1258 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1259 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1260 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1261
1262 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1263 @end deftypefn
1264
1265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
1266 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1267 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1268
1269 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1270 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1271 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1272 retain the field's mode.
1273
1274 Normally, this is not needed.
1275 @end deftypefn
1276
1277 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1278 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1279 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1280 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1281 @var{specified}.
1282
1283 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1284 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1285 @end defmac
1286
1287 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1288 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1289 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1290 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1291 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1292 (DImode)} is assumed.
1293 @end defmac
1294
1295 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1296 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1297 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1298 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1299 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1300 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1301 having its mode specified.
1302
1303 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1304 would most commonly define this macro if the
1305 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1306 64-bit mode.
1307 @end defmac
1308
1309 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1310 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1311 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1312 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1313
1314 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1315 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1316 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1317 @end defmac
1318
1319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1320 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1321 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1322 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1323 targets.
1324 @end deftypefn
1325
1326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1327 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1328 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1329 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1330 targets.
1331 @end deftypefn
1332
1333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1334 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1335 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1336 @end deftypefn
1337
1338 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1339 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1340 mode is towards zero.
1341
1342 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1343 floating-point arithmetic.
1344
1345 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1346 @end defmac
1347
1348 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1349 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1350 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1351 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1352
1353 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1354 floating-point arithmetic.
1355
1356 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1357 @end defmac
1358
1359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1360 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1361 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1362 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1363 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1364 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1365 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1366 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1367 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1368 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1369 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1370 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1371
1372 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1373 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1374 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1375 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1376 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1377 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1378 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1379
1380 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1381 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1382 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1383 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1384 may affect its placement.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1392 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1396 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1397 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1398 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1399 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1400 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1401 usage.
1402 @end deftypefn
1403
1404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1405 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1406 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1407 @end deftypefn
1408
1409 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1410 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1411 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1412 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1413 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1414 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1415 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1416 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1417 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1418 string constant.
1419
1420 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1421 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1422 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1423 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1424 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1425 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1426 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1427 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1428 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1429 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1430 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1431 spaces in your string.
1432
1433 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1434 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1435 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1436 before mangling.
1437
1438 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1439 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1440 types.
1441 @end deftypefn
1442
1443 @node Type Layout
1444 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1445
1446 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1447 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1448 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1449 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1450
1451 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1452 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1453 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1454 @end defmac
1455
1456 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1457 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1458 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1459 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1460 unit.)
1461 @end defmac
1462
1463 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1464 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1465 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1466 @end defmac
1467
1468 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1469 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1470 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1471 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1472 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1473 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1478 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1479 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1480 macro must be at least 64.
1481 @end defmac
1482
1483 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1484 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1485 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1486 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1491 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1492 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1493 @end defmac
1494
1495 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1496 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1497 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1498 @end defmac
1499
1500 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1502 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1503 words.
1504 @end defmac
1505
1506 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1507 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1508 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1509 words.
1510 @end defmac
1511
1512 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1514 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1516 @end defmac
1517
1518 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1520 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1522 @end defmac
1523
1524 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1526 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1528 @end defmac
1529
1530 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1531 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1532 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1534 @end defmac
1535
1536 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1538 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1540 @end defmac
1541
1542 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1544 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1546 @end defmac
1547
1548 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1550 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1552 @end defmac
1553
1554 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1555 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1556 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1561 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1562 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1563 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1564 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1565 @end defmac
1566
1567 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1568 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1569 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1570 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1571 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1572 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1573 otherwise it is 0.
1574 @end defmac
1575
1576 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1577 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1578 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581 @end defmac
1582
1583 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1584 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1585 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1586 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1587 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1588 @end defmac
1589
1590 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1591 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1592 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1593 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1594 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1595 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1596 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1597 @end defmac
1598
1599 @defmac SF_SIZE
1600 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1601 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1602 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1603 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1604 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1605 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1606 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1607 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1608 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1609 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1610 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1611 @end defmac
1612
1613 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1614 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1615 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1616 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1617 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1618 @end defmac
1619
1620 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1621 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1622 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1623 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1624 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1625 is the default.
1626 @end defmac
1627
1628 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1629 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1630 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1631 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1632 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1633 @end defmac
1634
1635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1636 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1637 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1638 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1639 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1640
1641 The default is to return false.
1642 @end deftypefn
1643
1644 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1645 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1646 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1647 contents of the string.
1648
1649 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1650 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1651 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1652 of the data type names defined in the function
1653 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1654 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1655 compiler to crash on startup.
1656
1657 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1658 int"}.
1659 @end defmac
1660
1661 @defmac SIZETYPE
1662 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1663 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1664 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1665 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1666 is extracted.
1667
1668 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1669
1670 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1671 @end defmac
1672
1673 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1674 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1675 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1676 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1677 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1683 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1684 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1685 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1686 information.
1687
1688 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1689 @end defmac
1690
1691 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1692 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1693 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1694 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1695 @end defmac
1696
1697 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1698 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1699 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1700 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1701 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1702 information.
1703
1704 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1705 @end defmac
1706
1707 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1708 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1709 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1710 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1711 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1712
1713 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1714 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1715 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1716 @end defmac
1717
1718 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1719 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1720 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1721 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1722 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1723
1724 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1725 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1726 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1727 int}.
1728 @end defmac
1729
1730 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1731 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1732 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1733 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1734 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1735 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1736 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1737 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1738 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1739 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1740 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1741 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1742 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1743 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1744 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1745 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1746 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1747 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1748 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1749 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1750 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1751 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1752 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1753 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1754 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1755 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1756 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1757 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1758 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1759 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1760 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1761 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1762 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1763 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1764 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1765 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1766 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1767
1768 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1769 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1770 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1771 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1772 these macros are null pointers.
1773 @end defmac
1774
1775 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1776 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1777 that looks like:
1778
1779 @smallexample
1780 struct @{
1781 union @{
1782 void (*fn)();
1783 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1784 @};
1785 ptrdiff_t delta;
1786 @};
1787 @end smallexample
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1791 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1792 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1793 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1794 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1795 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1796 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1797 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1798
1799 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1800 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1801 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1802 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1803 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1804 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1805 architecture, you should define this macro to
1806 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1807
1808 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1809 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1810 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1811 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1812 @end defmac
1813
1814 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1815 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1816 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1817 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1818 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1819 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1820 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1821
1822 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1823 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1824 @end defmac
1825
1826 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1827 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1828 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1829 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1830 when special alignment is necessary. */
1831 @end defmac
1832
1833 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1834 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1835 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1836 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1837 of words in each data entry.
1838 @end defmac
1839
1840 @node Registers
1841 @section Register Usage
1842 @cindex register usage
1843
1844 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1845 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1846
1847 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1848 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1849 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1850 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1851 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1852
1853 @menu
1854 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1855 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1856 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1857 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1858 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1859 @end menu
1860
1861 @node Register Basics
1862 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1863
1864 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1865 Registers have various characteristics.
1866
1867 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1868 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1869 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1870 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1871 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1872 @end defmac
1873
1874 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1875 @cindex fixed register
1876 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1877 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1878 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1879 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1880 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1881 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1882 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1883
1884 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1885 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1886 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1887
1888 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1889 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1890 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1891 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1892 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1893 @end defmac
1894
1895 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1896 @cindex call-used register
1897 @cindex call-clobbered register
1898 @cindex call-saved register
1899 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1900 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1901 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1902 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1903 function calls.
1904
1905 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1906 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1907 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1908 @end defmac
1909
1910 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1911 @cindex call-used register
1912 @cindex call-clobbered register
1913 @cindex call-saved register
1914 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1915 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1916 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1917 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1918 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1919 @end defmac
1920
1921 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1922 @cindex call-used register
1923 @cindex call-clobbered register
1924 @cindex call-saved register
1925 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1926 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1927 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1928 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1929 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1930 @end defmac
1931
1932 @findex fixed_regs
1933 @findex call_used_regs
1934 @findex global_regs
1935 @findex reg_names
1936 @findex reg_class_contents
1937 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1938 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1939 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1940 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1941 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1942 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1943 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1944 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1945 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1946 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1947 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1948 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1949 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1950 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1951 command options have been applied.
1952
1953 @cindex disabling certain registers
1954 @cindex controlling register usage
1955 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1956 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1957 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1958 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1959 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1960 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1961 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1962
1963 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1964 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1965 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1966 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1967 @end deftypefn
1968
1969 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1970 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1971 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1972 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1973 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1974 outbound register.
1975 @end defmac
1976
1977 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1978 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1979 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1980 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1981 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1982 register.
1983 @end defmac
1984
1985 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1986 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1987 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1988 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1989 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1990 gotos.
1991 @end defmac
1992
1993 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1994 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1995 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1996 @end defmac
1997
1998 @node Allocation Order
1999 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2000 @cindex order of register allocation
2001 @cindex register allocation order
2002
2003 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2004 Registers are allocated in order.
2005
2006 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2007 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2008 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2009 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2010
2011 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2012 (all else being equal).
2013
2014 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2015 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2016 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2017 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2018 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2019 @end defmac
2020
2021 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2022 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2023 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2024
2025 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2026 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2027 register; and so on.
2028
2029 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2030 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2031
2032 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2033 @end defmac
2034
2035 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2036 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2037 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2038 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2039 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2040 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2041 should be defined.
2042 @end defmac
2043
2044 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2045 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2046 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2047 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2048 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2049 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2050 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2051 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2052
2053 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2054 @end defmac
2055
2056 @node Values in Registers
2057 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2058
2059 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2060 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2061 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2062
2063 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2064 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2065 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2066 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2067 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2068 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2069
2070 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2071 definition of this macro is
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2075 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2076 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2077 @end smallexample
2078 @end defmac
2079
2080 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2081 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2082 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2083 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2084 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2085 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2086 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2087
2088 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2089 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2090 nonzero.
2091
2092 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2093 @code{subreg_get_info}
2094 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2095 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2096 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2097 registers and so not be representable.
2098 @end defmac
2099
2100 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2101 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2102 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2103 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2104 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2105 @end defmac
2106
2107 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2108 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2109 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2110 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2111 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2112 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2113 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2114 @end defmac
2115
2116 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2117 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2118 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2119 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2120 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2121
2122 @smallexample
2123 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2124 @end smallexample
2125
2126 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2127 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2128
2129 @cindex register pairs
2130 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2131 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2132 odd register numbers for such modes.
2133
2134 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2135 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2136 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2137 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2138
2139 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2140 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2141 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2142 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2143 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2144 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2145 to be tieable.
2146
2147 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2148 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2149 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2150 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2151 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2152 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2153
2154 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2155 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2156 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2157 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2158 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2159 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2160 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2161 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2162 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2163
2164 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2165 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2166 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2167 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2168 constraints for those instructions.
2169
2170 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2171 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2172 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2173 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2174 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2175 @end defmac
2176
2177 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2178 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2179 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2180
2181 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2182 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2183 handler.
2184
2185 The default is always nonzero.
2186 @end defmac
2187
2188 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2189 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2190 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2191
2192 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2193 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2194 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2195 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2196 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2197 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2198
2199 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2200 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2201 allocation.
2202 @end defmac
2203
2204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2205 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2206 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2207
2208 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2209 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2210
2211 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2212 @end deftypefn
2213
2214 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2215 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2216 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2217 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2218 @end defmac
2219
2220 @node Leaf Functions
2221 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2222
2223 @cindex leaf functions
2224 @cindex functions, leaf
2225 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2226 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2227 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2228 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2229 normally arrive.
2230
2231 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2232 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2233 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2234 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2235 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2236 functions''.
2237
2238 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2239 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2240 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2241 accomplish this.
2242
2243 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2244 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2245 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2246 function treatment.
2247
2248 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2249 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2250 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2251 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2252 in this vector.
2253
2254 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2255 the treatment of leaf functions.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2259 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2260 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2261
2262 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2263 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2264 will cause the compiler to abort.
2265
2266 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2267 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2268 this.
2269 @end defmac
2270
2271 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2272 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2273 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2274 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2275 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2276 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2277 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2278 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2279 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2280 functions which only use leaf registers.
2281 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2282 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2283 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2284 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2285 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2286
2287 @node Stack Registers
2288 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2289
2290 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2291 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2292 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2293 stack.
2294
2295 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2296 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2297 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2298 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2299 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2300 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2301 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2302
2303 @defmac STACK_REGS
2304 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2305 @end defmac
2306
2307 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2308 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2309 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2310 @end defmac
2311
2312 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2313 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2314 of the stack.
2315 @end defmac
2316
2317 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2318 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2319 the stack.
2320 @end defmac
2321
2322 @node Register Classes
2323 @section Register Classes
2324 @cindex register class definitions
2325 @cindex class definitions, register
2326
2327 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2328 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2329 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2330 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2331
2332 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2333 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2334 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2335
2336 @findex ALL_REGS
2337 @findex NO_REGS
2338 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2339 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2340 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2341 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2342
2343 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2344 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2345 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2346 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2347 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2348 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2349
2350 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2351 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2352
2353 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2354 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2355 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2356 them in operand constraints.
2357
2358 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2359 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2360 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2361 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2362 (@pxref{Costs}).
2363
2364 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2365 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2366 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2367 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2368 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2369 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2370 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2371
2372 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2373 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2374 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2375 in their union.
2376
2377 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2378 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2379 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2380 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2381 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2382
2383 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2384 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2385 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2386 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2387 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2388 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2389 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2390 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2391 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2392
2393 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2394 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2395 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2396 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2397 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2398 tells how many classes there are.
2399
2400 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2401 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2402 in many of the tables described below.
2403 @end deftp
2404
2405 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2406 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2407
2408 @smallexample
2409 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2410 @end smallexample
2411 @end defmac
2412
2413 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2414 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2415 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2416 @end defmac
2417
2418 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2419 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2420 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2421 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2422 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2423
2424 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2425 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2426 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2427 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2428 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2429 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2430 so on.
2431 @end defmac
2432
2433 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2434 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2435 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2436 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2437 register.
2438 @end defmac
2439
2440 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2441 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2442 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2443 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2444 @end defmac
2445
2446 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2447 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2448 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2449 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2450 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2451 @end defmac
2452
2453 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2454 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2455 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2456 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2457 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2458 @end defmac
2459
2460 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2461 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2462 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2463 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2464 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2465 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2466 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2467 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2468 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2469 @end defmac
2470
2471 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2472 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2473 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2474 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2475 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2476 @end defmac
2477
2478 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2479 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2480 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2481 @end defmac
2482
2483 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2484 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2485 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2486 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2487 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2488 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2489 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2490 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2491 @code{address_operand}.
2492 @end defmac
2493
2494 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2495 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2496 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2497 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2498 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2499 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2500 than other base register uses.
2501
2502 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2503 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2504 @end defmac
2505
2506 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2507 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2508 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2509 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2510 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2511 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2512 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2513 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2514 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2515 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2516 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2517 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2518 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2519 @end defmac
2520
2521 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2522 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2523 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2524 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2525 allocated such a hard register.
2526
2527 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2528 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2529 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2530 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2531 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2532 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2533 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2534 only if neither labeling works.
2535 @end defmac
2536
2537 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2538 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2539 @end deftypefn
2540
2541 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2542 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2543 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2544 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2545 another, smaller class.
2546
2547 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2548
2549 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2550 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2551 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2552 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2553 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2554
2555 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2556 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2557 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2558 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2559 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2560 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2561 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2562 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2563 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2564 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2565 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2566
2567 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2568 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2569 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2570 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2571 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2572 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2573 @end deftypefn
2574
2575 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2576 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2577 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2578 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2579 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2580 safe:
2581
2582 @smallexample
2583 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2584 @end smallexample
2585
2586 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2587 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2588 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2589 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2590 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2591
2592 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2593 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2594 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2595 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2596 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2597 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2598 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2599 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2600 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2601 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2602 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2603
2604 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2605 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2606 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2607 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2608 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2609 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2610 @end defmac
2611
2612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2613 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2614 input reloads.
2615
2616 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2617 argument.
2618
2619 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2620 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2621 @end deftypefn
2622
2623 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2624 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2625 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2626 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2627 ordinarily be used.
2628
2629 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2630 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2631
2632 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2633 smaller class.
2634
2635 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2636 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2637 @end defmac
2638
2639 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, enum machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2640 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2641 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2642 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2643 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2644 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2645 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2646 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2647 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2648 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2649 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2650 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2651 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2652
2653 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2654 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2655 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2656 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2657 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2658 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2659 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2660 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2661 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2662 of the scratch register(s).
2663
2664 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2665
2666 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2667 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2668 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2669 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2670 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2671
2672 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2673 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2674 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2675 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2676 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2677 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2678
2679 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2680 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2681 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2682 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2683 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2684
2685 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2686 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2687 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2688 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2689 single-register-class
2690 @c [later: or memory]
2691 output constraint.
2692
2693 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2694 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2695 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2696 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2697
2698 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2699 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2700 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2701 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2702 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2703 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2704 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2705 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2706
2707
2708 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2709 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2710 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2711 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2712
2713 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2714 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2715 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2716
2717 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2718 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2719 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2720 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2721 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2722 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2723 @end deftypefn
2724
2725 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2726 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2727 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2728 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2729 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2730
2731 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2732 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2733 reload phase that it may
2734 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2735 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2736 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2737 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2738 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2739 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2740
2741 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2742 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2743 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2744 class required. If the
2745 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2746 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2747 macros identically.
2748
2749 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2750 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2751 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2752 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2753 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2754
2755 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2756 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2757 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2758 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2759 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2760 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2761 register.
2762
2763 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2764 register that
2765 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2766 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2767 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2768 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2769 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2770
2771 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2772 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2773 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2774 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2775
2776 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2777 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2778 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2779 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2780 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2781 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2782 general registers.
2783 @end defmac
2784
2785 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2786 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2787 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2788 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2789 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2790 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2791 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2792
2793 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2794 @end defmac
2795
2796 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2797 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2798 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2799 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2800 defined by this macro.
2801
2802 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2803 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2804 @end defmac
2805
2806 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2807 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2808 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2809 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2810 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2811 same as that of @var{mode}.
2812
2813 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2814 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2815 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2816 registers.
2817
2818 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2819 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2820 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2821 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2822 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2823 details.
2824
2825 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2826 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2827 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2828 @end defmac
2829
2830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2831 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2832 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2833 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2834
2835 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2836 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2837 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2838 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2839 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2840
2841 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2842 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2843 pressure.
2844 @end deftypefn
2845
2846 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
2847 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2848 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2849
2850 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2851 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2852 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2853 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2854 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2855
2856 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2857 in the reload pass.
2858
2859 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2860 in words.
2861 @end deftypefn
2862
2863 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2864 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2865 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2866
2867 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2868 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2869 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2870 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2871
2872 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2873 in the reload pass.
2874 @end defmac
2875
2876 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2877 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2878 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2879
2880 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2881 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2882 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2883 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2884 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2885 as below:
2886
2887 @smallexample
2888 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2889 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2890 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2891 @end smallexample
2892 @end defmac
2893
2894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2895 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2896 @end deftypefn
2897
2898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2899 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2900 @end deftypefn
2901
2902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2903 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2904 @end deftypefn
2905
2906 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, enum @var{machine_mode})
2907 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2908 @end deftypefn
2909
2910 @node Old Constraints
2911 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2912 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2913 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2914
2915 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2916 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2917 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2918 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2919
2920 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2921 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2922 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2923 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2924 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2925 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2926 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2927 to handle specially.
2928 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2929 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2930 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2931 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2932 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2933 @end defmac
2934
2935 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2936 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2937 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2938 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2939 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2940 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2941 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2942 @end defmac
2943
2944 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2945 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2946 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2947 different variants.
2948 @end defmac
2949
2950 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2951 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2952 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2953 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2954 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2955 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2956 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2957 @var{value}.
2958 @end defmac
2959
2960 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2961 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2962 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2963 between different variants.
2964 @end defmac
2965
2966 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2967 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2968 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2969 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2970
2971 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2972 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2973 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2974 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2975
2976 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2977 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2978 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2979 between these kinds.
2980 @end defmac
2981
2982 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2983 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2984 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2985 between different variants.
2986 @end defmac
2987
2988 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2989 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2990 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2991 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2992 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2993 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2994 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2995
2996 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2997 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2998 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2999 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3000
3001 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3002 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3003 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3004 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3005 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3006 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3007 does not include r0 on the output.
3008 @end defmac
3009
3010 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3011 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3012 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3013 variants.
3014 @end defmac
3015
3016 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3017 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3018 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3019 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3020
3021 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3022 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3023 comprises a subset of all memory references including
3024 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3025 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3026 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3027
3028 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3029 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3030 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3031 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3032 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3033 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3034 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3035 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3036 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3037 @end defmac
3038
3039 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3040 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3041 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3042 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3043 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3044
3045 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3046 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3047 a subset of all memory addresses including
3048 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3049 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3050 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3051
3052 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3053 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3054 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3055 @end defmac
3056
3057 @node Stack and Calling
3058 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3059 @cindex calling conventions
3060
3061 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3062 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3063
3064 @menu
3065 * Frame Layout::
3066 * Exception Handling::
3067 * Stack Checking::
3068 * Frame Registers::
3069 * Elimination::
3070 * Stack Arguments::
3071 * Register Arguments::
3072 * Scalar Return::
3073 * Aggregate Return::
3074 * Caller Saves::
3075 * Function Entry::
3076 * Profiling::
3077 * Tail Calls::
3078 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3079 @end menu
3080
3081 @node Frame Layout
3082 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3083 @cindex stack frame layout
3084 @cindex frame layout
3085
3086 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3087 Here is the basic stack layout.
3088
3089 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3090 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3091 pointer to a smaller address.
3092
3093 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3094 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3095 definition used does not matter.
3096 @end defmac
3097
3098 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3099 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3100 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3101 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3102
3103 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3104 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3105 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3106 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3107 space for the next item on the stack.
3108
3109 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3110 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3111 which is often wrong.
3112 @end defmac
3113
3114 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3115 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3116 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3117 @end defmac
3118
3119 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3120 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3121 addresses on the stack.
3122 @end defmac
3123
3124 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3125 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3126
3127 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3128 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3129 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3130 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3131 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3132 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3133 @end defmac
3134
3135 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3136 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3137 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3138
3139 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3140 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3141 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3142 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3143 @end defmac
3144
3145 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3146 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3147 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3148 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3149
3150 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3151 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3152 @end defmac
3153
3154 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3155 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3156 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3157 function.
3158
3159 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3160 the first argument's address.
3161 @end defmac
3162
3163 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3164 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3165 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3166
3167 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3168 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3169 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3170 @end defmac
3171
3172 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3173 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3174 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3175 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3176 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3177 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3178 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3179 @end defmac
3180
3181 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3182 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3183 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3184 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3185 itself.
3186
3187 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3188 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3189 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3190 @end defmac
3191
3192 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3193 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3194 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3195 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3196 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3197 define this macro.
3198 @end defmac
3199
3200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3201 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3202 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3203 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3204 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3205 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3206 @end deftypefn
3207
3208 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3209 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3210 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3211 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3212 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3213 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3214 @end defmac
3215
3216 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3217 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3218 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3219 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3220 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3221 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3222
3223 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3224 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3225 determine the return address of other frames.
3226 @end defmac
3227
3228 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3229 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3230 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3231 @end defmac
3232
3233 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3234 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3235 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3236 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3237 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3238 the stack.
3239
3240 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3241 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3242
3243 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3244 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3245 @end defmac
3246
3247 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3248 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3249 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3250 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3251 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3252
3253 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3254 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3255 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3256 over time.
3257 @end defmac
3258
3259 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3260 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3261 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3262 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3263 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3264 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3265 @end defmac
3266
3267 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3268 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3269 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3270 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3271 @smallexample
3272 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3273 @end smallexample
3274 and
3275 @smallexample
3276 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3277 @end smallexample
3278 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3279 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3280 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3281 @end deftypefn
3282
3283 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3284 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3285 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3286 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3287 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3288 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3289
3290 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3291 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3292 @end defmac
3293
3294 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3295 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3296 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3297 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3298 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3299 during virtual register instantiation.
3300
3301 The default value for this macro is
3302 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3303 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3304 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3305 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3306 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3307
3308 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3309 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3310 DWARF 2.
3311 @end defmac
3312
3313 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3314 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3315 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3316 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3317 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3318
3319 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3320 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3321 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3322 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3323 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3324 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3325 should be defined.
3326 @end defmac
3327
3328 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3329 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3330 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3331 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3332 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3333 @end defmac
3334
3335 @node Exception Handling
3336 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3337 @cindex exception handling
3338
3339 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3340 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3341 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3342 @var{N} registers are usable.
3343
3344 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3345 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3346 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3347 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3348 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3349
3350 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3351 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3352 @end defmac
3353
3354 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3355 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3356 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3357 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3358 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3359
3360 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3361 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3362
3363 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3364 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3365 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3366 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3367 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3368 that provided by DWARF 2.
3369 @end defmac
3370
3371 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3372 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3373 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3374 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3375
3376 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3377 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3378 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3379 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3380 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3381 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3382 target call frame.
3383
3384 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3385 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3386 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3387
3388 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3389 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3390 @end defmac
3391
3392 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3393 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3394 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3395 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3396 using it to return to the exception handler.
3397 @end defmac
3398
3399 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3400 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3401 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3402 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3403 and so may be read-only.
3404
3405 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3406 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3407 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3408 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3409
3410 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3411 represented directly.
3412 @end defmac
3413
3414 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3415 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3416 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3417 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3418 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3419
3420 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3421 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3422 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3423 to be emitted.
3424 @end defmac
3425
3426 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3427 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3428 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3429 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3430 through signal frames.
3431
3432 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3433 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3434 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3435 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3436 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3437 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3438 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3439 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3440 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3441
3442 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3443 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3444 @end defmac
3445
3446 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3447 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3448 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3449 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3450
3451 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3452 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3453 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3454 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3455 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3456 be updated in @var{fs}.
3457 @end defmac
3458
3459 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3460 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3461 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3462 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3463 @end defmac
3464
3465 @node Stack Checking
3466 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3467
3468 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3469 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3470 three ways:
3471
3472 @enumerate
3473 @item
3474 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3475 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3476 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3477 other special processing.
3478
3479 @item
3480 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3481 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3482 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3483 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3484 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3485 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3486 approach below.
3487
3488 @item
3489 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3490 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3491 @end enumerate
3492
3493 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3494 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3495 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3496 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3497
3498 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3499 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3500 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3501 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3502 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3503 value of this macro is zero.
3504 @end defmac
3505
3506 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3507 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3508 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3509 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3510 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3511 @end defmac
3512
3513 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3514 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3515 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3516 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3517 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3518 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3519 @end defmac
3520
3521 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3522 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3523 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3524 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3525 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3526 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3527 default value of this macro is zero.
3528 @end defmac
3529
3530 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3531 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3532 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3533 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3534 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3535 most machines.
3536 @end defmac
3537
3538 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3539 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3540 in the opposite case.
3541
3542 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3543 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3544 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3545 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3546 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3547 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3548 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3549 @end defmac
3550
3551 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3552 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3553 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3554 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3555 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3556 use the default of four words.
3557 @end defmac
3558
3559 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3560 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3561 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3562 @option{-fstack-check}.
3563 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3564 normally not need to override that default.
3565 @end defmac
3566
3567 @need 2000
3568 @node Frame Registers
3569 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3570
3571 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3572 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3573
3574 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3575 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3576 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3577 the hardware determines which register this is.
3578 @end defmac
3579
3580 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3581 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3582 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3583 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3584 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3585 @end defmac
3586
3587 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3588 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3589 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3590 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3591 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3592 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3593 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3594 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3595 used for the frame pointer.
3596
3597 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3598 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3599 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3600 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3601 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3602 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3603 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3604
3605 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3606 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3607 @end defmac
3608
3609 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3610 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3611 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3612 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3613 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3614 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3615 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3616 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3617 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3618 @end defmac
3619
3620 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3621 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3622 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3623 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3624 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3625 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3626 @end defmac
3627
3628 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3629 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3630 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3631 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3632 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3633 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3634 @end defmac
3635
3636 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3637 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3638 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3639 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3640 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3641 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3642 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3643
3644 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3645 address from the stack.
3646 @end defmac
3647
3648 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3649 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3650 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3651 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3652 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3653 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3654 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3655 not be defined.
3656
3657 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3658
3659 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3660 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3661 @end defmac
3662
3663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3664 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3665 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3666 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3667 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3668 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3669
3670 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3671
3672 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3673 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3674 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3675 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3676 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3677 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3678 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3679 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3680 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3681 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3682 to refer to those items.
3683 @end deftypefn
3684
3685 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3686 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3687 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3688 DWARF2 exception handling.
3689
3690 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3691 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3692 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3693 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3694 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3695 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3696 registers that are not call-saved.
3697
3698 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3699 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3700 @end defmac
3701
3702 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3703
3704 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3705 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3706
3707 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3708 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3709 @end defmac
3710
3711 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3712
3713 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3714 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3715 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3716 column number to use instead.
3717
3718 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3719 @end defmac
3720
3721 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3722
3723 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3724 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3725 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3726 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3727 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3728
3729 @end defmac
3730
3731 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3732
3733 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3734 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3735 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3736 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3737 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3738
3739 @end defmac
3740
3741 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3742
3743 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3744 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3745 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3746 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3747
3748 @end defmac
3749
3750 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3751
3752 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3753 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3754 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3755 defined and 0 otherwise.
3756
3757 @end defmac
3758
3759 @node Elimination
3760 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3761
3762 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3763 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3764
3765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3766 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3767 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3768 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3769
3770 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3771 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3772 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3773 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3774 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3775 pointer.
3776
3777 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3778 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3779 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3780 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3781 them.
3782
3783 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3784 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3785 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3786
3787 Default return value is @code{false}.
3788 @end deftypefn
3789
3790 @findex get_frame_size
3791 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3792 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3793 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3794 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3795 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3796 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3797
3798 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3799 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3800 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3801 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3802 @end defmac
3803
3804 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3805 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3806 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3807 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3808 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3809
3810 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3811 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3812
3813 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3814 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3815 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3816 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3817 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3818
3819 In this case, you might specify:
3820 @smallexample
3821 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3822 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3823 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3824 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3825 @end smallexample
3826
3827 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3828 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3829 @end defmac
3830
3831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3832 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3833 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3834 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3835 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3836 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3837 knows about.
3838
3839 Default return value is @code{true}.
3840 @end deftypefn
3841
3842 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3843 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3844 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3845 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3846 defined.
3847 @end defmac
3848
3849 @node Stack Arguments
3850 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3851 @cindex arguments on stack
3852 @cindex stack arguments
3853
3854 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3855 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3856 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3857
3858 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3859 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3860 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3861 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3862 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3863 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3864 @end deftypefn
3865
3866 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3867 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3868 outgoing arguments.
3869 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3870 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3871 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3872 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3873 @end defmac
3874
3875 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3876 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3877 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3878 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3879 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3880 @end defmac
3881
3882 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3883 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3884 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3885
3886 On some machines, the definition
3887
3888 @smallexample
3889 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3890 @end smallexample
3891
3892 @noindent
3893 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3894 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3895 alignment. Then the definition should be
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3902 @end defmac
3903
3904 @findex outgoing_args_size
3905 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3906 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3907 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3908 will be computed and placed into
3909 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3910 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3911 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3912
3913 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3914 is not proper.
3915 @end defmac
3916
3917 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3918 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3919 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3920 registers.
3921
3922 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3923 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3924 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3925 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3926 of the function.
3927
3928 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3929 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3930 which.
3931 @end defmac
3932 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3933 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3934
3935 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3936 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3937 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3938 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3939 if the function called is a library function.
3940
3941 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3942 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3943 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3944 @end defmac
3945
3946 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3947 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3948 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3949 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3950 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3951
3952 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3953 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3954 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3955 stack in its natural location.
3956 @end defmac
3957
3958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3959 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3960 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3961 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3962
3963 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3964 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3965 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3966 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3967
3968 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3969 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3970 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3971 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3972 arguments (if known).
3973
3974 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3975 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3976 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3977 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3978 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3979 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3980
3981 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3982 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3983 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3984
3985 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3986 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3987 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3988 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3989 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3990 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3991 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3992 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3993 number of arguments.
3994 @end deftypefn
3995
3996 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3997 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3998 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3999 when compiling a function call.
4000
4001 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4002 have been accumulated.
4003
4004 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4005 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4006 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4007 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4008 appropriate.
4009 @end defmac
4010
4011 @node Register Arguments
4012 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4013 @cindex arguments in registers
4014 @cindex registers arguments
4015
4016 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4017 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4018 the stack.
4019
4020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4021 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
4022 register and if so, which register.
4023
4024 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
4025 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4026 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4027 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4028 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
4029 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
4030 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
4031 syntax error has previously occurred.
4032
4033 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4034 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
4035 on the stack.
4036
4037 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4038 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4039 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4040 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4041 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4042 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4043 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4044 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4045 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4046 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4047 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4048 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4049 argument is also stored on the stack.
4050
4051 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4052 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4053 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4054
4055 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4056 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4057 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4058 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4059 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4060 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4061
4062 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4063 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4064 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4065 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4066 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4067 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4068 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4069 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4070 a register.
4071 @end deftypefn
4072
4073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4074 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4075 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4076 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4077 documentation.
4078 @end deftypefn
4079
4080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4081 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4082 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4083 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4084 argument.
4085
4086 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4087 which the caller passes the value, and
4088 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4089 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4090 arrive.
4091
4092 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4093 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4094 @end deftypefn
4095
4096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4097 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4098 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4099 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4100 pushed on the stack.
4101
4102 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4103 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4104 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4105 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4106 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4107 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4108 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4109
4110 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4111 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4112 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4113 @end deftypefn
4114
4115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4116 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4117 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4118 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4119 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4120
4121 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4122 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4123 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4124 to that type.
4125 @end deftypefn
4126
4127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4128 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4129 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4130 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4131 by the caller.
4132
4133 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4134 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4135 not be generated.
4136
4137 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4138 @end deftypefn
4139
4140 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4141 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4142 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4143 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4144 of bytes of argument so far.
4145
4146 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4147 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4148 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4149 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4150 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4151 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4152 @end defmac
4153
4154 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4155 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4156 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4157 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4158 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4159 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4160 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4161 @end defmac
4162
4163 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4164 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4165 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4166 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4167 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4168 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4169 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4170 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4171 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4172 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4173 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4174 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4175 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4176
4177 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4178 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4179 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4180 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4181 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4182 never both of them at once.
4183 @end defmac
4184
4185 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4186 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4187 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4188 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4189 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4190 0)} is used instead.
4191 @end defmac
4192
4193 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4194 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4195 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4196 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4197
4198 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4199 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4200 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4201 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4202 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4203 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4204 @end defmac
4205
4206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4207 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4208 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4209 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4210 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4211 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4212
4213 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4214 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4215 used for arguments without any special help.
4216 @end deftypefn
4217
4218 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4219 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4220 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4221 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4222 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4223 top.
4224 @end defmac
4225
4226 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4227 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4228 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4229 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4230 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4231
4232 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4233 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4234 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4235
4236 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4237 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4238 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4239 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4240 @end defmac
4241
4242 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4243 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4244 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4245 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4246 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4247 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4248 @end defmac
4249
4250 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4251 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4252 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4253 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4254 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4255 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4256 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4257 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4258 required.
4259 @end defmac
4260
4261 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4262 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4263 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4264 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4265 @end deftypefn
4266
4267 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4268 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4269 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4270 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4271 value.
4272 @end deftypefn
4273
4274 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4275 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4276 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4277 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4278 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4279 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4280 stack.
4281 @end defmac
4282
4283 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4284 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4285 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4286 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4287 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4288 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4289 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4290 point register.
4291
4292 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4293 false.
4294 @end deftypefn
4295
4296 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4297 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4298 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4299 @end deftypefn
4300
4301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4302 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4303 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4304 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4305 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4306 variable.
4307 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4308 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4309 internal type.
4310 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4311 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4312 macro to iterate through all types.
4313 @end deftypefn
4314
4315 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4316 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4317 @var{fndecl}.
4318 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4319 @end deftypefn
4320
4321 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4322 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4323 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4324 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4325 @end deftypefn
4326
4327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4328 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4329 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4330 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4331 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4332 @end deftypefn
4333
4334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4335 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4336 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4337 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4338 @end deftypefn
4339
4340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref_s *@var{ref})
4341 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4342 @end deftypefn
4343
4344 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4345 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4346 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4347 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4348 must work.
4349
4350 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4351 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4352 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4353 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4354 @end deftypefn
4355
4356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4357 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4358 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4359 must have move patterns for this mode.
4360 @end deftypefn
4361
4362 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4363 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4364 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4365 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4366 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4367
4368 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4369 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4370 has operations like:
4371
4372 @smallexample
4373 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 where the return type is defined as:
4377
4378 @smallexample
4379 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4380 @{
4381 int8x8_t val[3];
4382 @} int8x8x3_t;
4383 @end smallexample
4384
4385 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4386 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4387 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4388 @end deftypefn
4389
4390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
4391 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4392 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4393 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4394 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4395 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4396 for any mode.
4397
4398 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4399 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4400 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4401 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4402 insn.
4403
4404 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4405 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4406 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4407 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4408 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4409 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4410 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4411 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4412 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4413
4414 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4415 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4416 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4417 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4418 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4419 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4420 @end deftypefn
4421
4422 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4423 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
4424 @end deftypevr
4425
4426 @node Scalar Return
4427 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4428 @cindex return values in registers
4429 @cindex values, returned by functions
4430 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4431
4432 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4433 values---values that can fit in registers.
4434
4435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4436
4437 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4438 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4439 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4440 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4441 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4442 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4443 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4444 a function returns a value.
4445
4446 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4447 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4448 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4449 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4450 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4451 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4452 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4453 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4454 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4455 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4456 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4457 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4458
4459 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4460 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4461 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4462
4463 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4464 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4465 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4466 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4467 known.
4468
4469 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4470 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4471 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4472 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4473
4474 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4475 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4476 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4477 @end deftypefn
4478
4479 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4480 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4481 a new target instead.
4482 @end defmac
4483
4484 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4485 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4486 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4487
4488 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4489 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4490 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4491 compiled.
4492 @end defmac
4493
4494 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4495 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4496 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4497
4498 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4499 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4500 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4501
4502 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4503 @end deftypefn
4504
4505 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4506 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4507 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4508
4509 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4510 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4511 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4512 suffices:
4513
4514 @smallexample
4515 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4516 @end smallexample
4517
4518 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4519 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4520 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4521
4522 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4523 for a new target instead.
4524 @end defmac
4525
4526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4527 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4528 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4529
4530 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4531 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4532 recognized by this target hook.
4533
4534 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4535 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4536 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4537
4538 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4539 @end deftypefn
4540
4541 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4542 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4543 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4544 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4545 @end defmac
4546
4547 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4548 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4549 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4550 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4551 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4552
4553 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4554 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4555 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4556 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4557 @code{SImode} rtx.
4558 @end deftypefn
4559
4560 @node Aggregate Return
4561 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4562 @cindex aggregates as return values
4563 @cindex large return values
4564 @cindex returning aggregate values
4565 @cindex structure value address
4566
4567 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4568 cases), the value is not returned according to
4569 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4570 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4571 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4572 address}.
4573
4574 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4575 memory.
4576
4577 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4578 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4579 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4580 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4581 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4582 libcalls.
4583
4584 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4585 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4586 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4587 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4588 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4589 values, and 0 otherwise.
4590
4591 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4592 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4593 to indicate this.
4594 @end deftypefn
4595
4596 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4597 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4598 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4599 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4600 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4601 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4602 target hook.
4603
4604 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4605 @end defmac
4606
4607 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4608 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4609 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4610 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4611 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4612 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4613 argument.
4614
4615 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4616 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4617 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4618 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4619 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4620 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4621 the caller.
4622
4623 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4624 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4625 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4626 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4627 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4628 @end deftypefn
4629
4630 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4631 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4632 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4633 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4634
4635 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4636 pass an address to the subroutine.
4637
4638 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4639 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4640 @end defmac
4641
4642 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4643 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4644 @end deftypefn
4645
4646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4647 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4648 @end deftypefn
4649
4650 @node Caller Saves
4651 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4652
4653 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4654 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4655 must live across calls.
4656
4657 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4658 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4659 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4660 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4661 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4662
4663 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4664 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4665 @end defmac
4666
4667 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4668 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4669 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4670 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4671 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4672 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4673 @end defmac
4674
4675 @node Function Entry
4676 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4677 @cindex function entry and exit
4678 @cindex prologue
4679 @cindex epilogue
4680
4681 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4682 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4683
4684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4685 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4686 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4687 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4688 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4689 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4690 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4691
4692 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4693 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4694
4695 @findex regs_ever_live
4696 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4697 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4698 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4699 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4700 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4701 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4702
4703 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4704 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4705 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4706 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4707 registers are used in the function.
4708
4709 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4710 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4711 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4712 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4713 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4714 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4715 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4716
4717 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4718 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4719 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4720 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4721 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4722 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4723 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4724 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4725 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4726 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4727 @end deftypefn
4728
4729 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4730 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4731 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4732 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4733 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4734 @end deftypefn
4735
4736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4737 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4738 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4739 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4740 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4741 @end deftypefn
4742
4743 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4744 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4745 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4746 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4747 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4748 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4749 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4750 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4751
4752 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4753 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4754 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4755 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4756
4757 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4758 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4759 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4760 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4761 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4762 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4763
4764 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4765 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4766 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4767 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4768 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4769 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4770
4771 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4772 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4773 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4774 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4775
4776 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4777 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4778 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4779 number of arguments.
4780
4781 @findex pops_args
4782 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4783 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4784 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4785 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4786 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4787 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4788 @end deftypefn
4789
4790 @itemize @bullet
4791 @item
4792 @findex pretend_args_size
4793 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4794 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4795 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4796 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4797 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4798 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4799 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4800 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4801 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4802 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4803
4804 @item
4805 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4806 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4807 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4808 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4809 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4810 a save area.
4811
4812 @item
4813 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4814 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4815 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4816 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4817
4818 @item
4819 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4820 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4821 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4822 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4823 @end itemize
4824
4825 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4826 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4827 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4828 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4829 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4830 default is 0.
4831
4832 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4833 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4834 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4835 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4836 @end defmac
4837
4838 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4839 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4840 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4841 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4842 @end defmac
4843
4844 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4845 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4846 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4847 on entry to an exception edge.
4848 @end defmac
4849
4850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4851 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4852 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4853 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4854 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4855 the real function.
4856
4857 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4858 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4859 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4860 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4861 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4862 all other incoming arguments.
4863
4864 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4865 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4866 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4867
4868 @smallexample
4869 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4870 @end smallexample
4871
4872 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4873 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4874 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4875 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4876
4877 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4878 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4879 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4880 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4881
4882 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4883 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4884 some targets, but probably not.
4885
4886 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4887 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4888 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4889 not support varargs.
4890 @end deftypefn
4891
4892 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4893 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4894 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4895 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4896 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4897 previously exposed.
4898 @end deftypefn
4899
4900 @node Profiling
4901 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4902 @cindex profiling, code generation
4903
4904 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4905
4906 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4907 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4908 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4909
4910 @findex mcount
4911 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4912 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4913 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4914 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4915
4916 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4917 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4918 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4919 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4920 @end defmac
4921
4922 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4923 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4924 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4925 not support profiling.
4926 @end defmac
4927
4928 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4929 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4930 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4931 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4932 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4933 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4934 @end defmac
4935
4936 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4937 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4938 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4939 @end defmac
4940
4941 @node Tail Calls
4942 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4943 @cindex tail calls
4944
4945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4946 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4947 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4948 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4949
4950 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4951 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4952 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4953 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4954 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4955 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4956 @end deftypefn
4957
4958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4959 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4960 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4961 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4962 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4963 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4964 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4965 @end deftypefn
4966
4967 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4968 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4969 @end deftypefn
4970
4971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4972 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4973 @end deftypefn
4974
4975 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4976 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4977 @cindex stack smashing protection
4978
4979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4980 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4981 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4982 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4983 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4984 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4985
4986 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4987 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4988 @end deftypefn
4989
4990 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4991 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4992 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4993 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4994
4995 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4996 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4997 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4998 @end deftypefn
4999
5000 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5001 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5002 @end deftypefn
5003
5004 @node Varargs
5005 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5006 @cindex varargs implementation
5007
5008 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5009 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5010 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5011 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5012 conditionals to include it.
5013
5014 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5015 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5016 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5017 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5018 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5019 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5020
5021 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5022 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5023 below.
5024
5025 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5026 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5027 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5028 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5029 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5030
5031 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5032 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5033 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5034 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5035
5036 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5037 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5038 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5039 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5040 to use them for its own purposes.
5041 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5042 @c 10feb93
5043 @end defmac
5044
5045 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5046 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5047 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5048 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5049 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5050 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5051 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5052 of the current function.
5053 @end defmac
5054
5055 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5056 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5057 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5058 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5059 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5060 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5061
5062 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5063 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5064 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5065
5066 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5067 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5068 @end defmac
5069
5070 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5071
5072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5073 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5074 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5075 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5076 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5077 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5078 @end deftypefn
5079
5080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5081 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5082 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5083 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5084 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5085 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5086 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5087 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5088
5089 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5090 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5091 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5092 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5093
5094 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5095 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5096 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5097 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5098 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5099 frame.
5100
5101 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5102 compile time without knowing their data types,
5103 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5104 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5105 for all data types.
5106
5107 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5108 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5109 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5110 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5111 not generate any instructions in this case.
5112 @end deftypefn
5113
5114 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5115 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5116 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5117
5118 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5119 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5120 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5121 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5122 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5123 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5124 except the last are treated as named.
5125
5126 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5127 @end deftypefn
5128
5129 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5130 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5131 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5132 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5133 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5134 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5135 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5136 @end deftypefn
5137
5138 @node Trampolines
5139 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5140 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5141 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5142
5143 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5144 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5145 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5146 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5147 trampoline.
5148
5149 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5150 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5151 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5152 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5153 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5154 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5155 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5156 operands.
5157
5158 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5159 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5160 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5161 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5162 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5163 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5164 separately.
5165
5166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5167 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5168 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5169 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5170 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5171
5172 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5173 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5174 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5175 to generate it on the spot.
5176 @end deftypefn
5177
5178 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5179 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5180 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5181 @end defmac
5182
5183 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5184 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5185 @end defmac
5186
5187 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5188 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5189
5190 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5191 is used for aligning trampolines.
5192 @end defmac
5193
5194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5195 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5196 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5197 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5198 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5199 when it is called.
5200
5201 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5202 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5203 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5204 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5205 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5206 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5207
5208 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5209 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5210 initializing the trampoline proper.
5211 @end deftypefn
5212
5213 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5214 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5215 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5216 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5217 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5218 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5219 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5220 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5221 @end deftypefn
5222
5223 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5224 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5225 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5226 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5227
5228 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5229 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5230 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5231 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5232 latter makes initialization faster.
5233
5234 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5235 the following macro.
5236
5237 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5238 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5239 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5240 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5241 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5242 @end defmac
5243
5244 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5245 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5246 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5247 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5248 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5249
5250 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5251 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5252 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5253 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5254 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5255
5256 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5257 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5258 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5259 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5260 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5261 special assembler code.
5262 @end defmac
5263
5264 @node Library Calls
5265 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5266 @cindex library subroutine names
5267 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5268
5269 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5270 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5271
5272 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5273 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5274 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5275 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5276 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5277 @end defmac
5278
5279 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5280 @findex init_one_libfunc
5281 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5282 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5283 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5284 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5285 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5286 library routines.
5287
5288 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5289 @end deftypefn
5290
5291 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5292 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5293 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5294 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5295 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5296 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5297 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5298 @end deftypevr
5299
5300 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5301 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5302 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5303 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5304 return a tristate.
5305
5306 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5307 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5308 don't need to define this macro.
5309 @end defmac
5310
5311 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5312 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5313 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5314 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5315 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5316 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5317 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5318 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5319 @end defmac
5320
5321 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5322 @findex matherr
5323 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5324 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5325 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5326 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5327 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5328 system.
5329
5330 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5331 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5332 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5333 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5334 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5335 @end defmac
5336
5337 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5338 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5339 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5340 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5341 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5342 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5343 @end defmac
5344
5345 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5346 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5347 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5348 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5349 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5350 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5351 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5352 @end defmac
5353
5354 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5355 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5356 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5357 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5358 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5359 @smallexample
5360 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5361 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5362 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5363 @end smallexample
5364 @end defmac
5365
5366 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5367 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5368 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5369 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5370 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5371 the NeXT runtime installed.
5372
5373 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5374 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5375 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5376
5377 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5378 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5379 @end defmac
5380
5381 @node Addressing Modes
5382 @section Addressing Modes
5383 @cindex addressing modes
5384
5385 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5386 This is about addressing modes.
5387
5388 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5389 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5390 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5391 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5392 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5393 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5394 @end defmac
5395
5396 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5397 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5398 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5399 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5400 the size of the memory operand.
5401 @end defmac
5402
5403 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5404 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5405 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5406 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5407 @end defmac
5408
5409 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5410 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5411 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5412 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5413 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5414 constant addresses are supported.
5415 @end defmac
5416
5417 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5418 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5419 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5420 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5421 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5422 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5423 @end defmac
5424
5425 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5426 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5427 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5428 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5429 accept.
5430 @end defmac
5431
5432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5433 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5434 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5435
5436 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5437 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5438 desired by the caller.
5439
5440 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5441 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5442 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5443 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5444 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5445 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5446 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5447 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5448
5449 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5450 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5451 register is required.
5452
5453 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5454 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5455 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5456 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5457 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5458
5459 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5460 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5461 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5462 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5463 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5464
5465 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5466 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5467 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5468 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5469 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5470 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5471 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5472 Format}.
5473
5474 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5475 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5476 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5477 has this syntax:
5478
5479 @example
5480 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5481 @end example
5482
5483 @noindent
5484 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5485 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5486
5487 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5488 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5489 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5490 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5491 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5492
5493 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5494 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5495 @end deftypefn
5496
5497 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5498 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5499 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5500 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5501 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5502 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5503 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5504 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5505 @code{'m'} constraint.
5506 @end defmac
5507
5508 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5509 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5510 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5511 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5512 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5513
5514 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5515 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5516
5517 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5518 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5519 @end defmac
5520
5521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5522 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5523 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5524 address.
5525
5526 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5527 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5528 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5529 @var{x}.
5530
5531 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5532 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5533 should return the new @var{x}.
5534
5535 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5536 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5537 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5538 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5539 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5540 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5541 strategy can generate better code.
5542 @end deftypefn
5543
5544 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5545 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5546 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5547 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5548 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5549 performance reasons.
5550
5551 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5552 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5553 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5554 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5555 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5556 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5557 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5558 be shared.
5559
5560 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5561 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5562 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5563 of reload internals.
5564
5565 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5566 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5567 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5568
5569 @findex push_reload
5570 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5571 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5572 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5573
5574 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5575 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5576 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5577 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5578 @code{push_reload}.
5579
5580 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5581 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5582 the address has become legitimate.
5583
5584 @findex copy_rtx
5585 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5586 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5587 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5588 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5589 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5590 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5591 @end defmac
5592
5593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5594 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5595 space @var{addrspace} can have
5596 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5597 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5598 but not others.
5599
5600 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5601 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5602 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5603 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5604
5605 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5606
5607 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5608 @end deftypefn
5609
5610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5611 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5612 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5613 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5614
5615 The default definition returns true.
5616 @end deftypefn
5617
5618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5619 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5620 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5621 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5622 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5623 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5624 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5625 into their original form.
5626 @end deftypefn
5627
5628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5629 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5630 debug sections.
5631 @end deftypefn
5632
5633 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5634 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5635 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5636 of @var{x}.
5637
5638 The default version of this hook returns false.
5639
5640 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5641 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5642 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5643 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5644 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5645 @end deftypefn
5646
5647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5648 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5649 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5650 of @var{x}.
5651
5652 The default version returns false for all constants.
5653 @end deftypefn
5654
5655 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5656 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5657 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5658
5659 The default version returns true for all decls.
5660 @end deftypefn
5661
5662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5663 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5664 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5665 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5666 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5667 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5668 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5669 function are valid.
5670 @end deftypefn
5671
5672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5673 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5674 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5675 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5676 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5677
5678 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5679 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5680 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5681 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5682 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5683 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5684 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5685 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5686 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5687 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5688 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5689
5690 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5691 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5692 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5693 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5694 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5695 described above.
5696 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5697 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5698 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5699 @end deftypefn
5700
5701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5702 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5703 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5704 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5705 @end deftypefn
5706
5707 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5708 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5709 @end deftypefn
5710
5711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (enum @var{machine_mode}, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5712 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5713 @end deftypefn
5714
5715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5716 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5717 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5718 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5719 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5720 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5721
5722 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5723 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5724 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5725 @end deftypefn
5726
5727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5728 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5729 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5730 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5731 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5732 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5733 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5734 @end deftypefn
5735
5736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5737 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5738 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5739 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5740 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5741 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5742 @end deftypefn
5743
5744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
5745 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5746 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5747 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5748 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5749 @end deftypefn
5750
5751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5752 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5753 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5754 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5755 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5756 @end deftypefn
5757
5758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5759 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5760 @end deftypefn
5761
5762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5763 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5764 @end deftypefn
5765
5766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5767 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5768 @end deftypefn
5769
5770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5771 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5772 @end deftypefn
5773
5774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5775 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5776 @end deftypefn
5777
5778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5779 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5780 @end deftypefn
5781
5782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5783 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5784 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5785 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5786 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5787 loads.
5788 @end deftypefn
5789
5790 @node Anchored Addresses
5791 @section Anchored Addresses
5792 @cindex anchored addresses
5793 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5794
5795 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5796 For example, if we have:
5797
5798 @smallexample
5799 static int a, b, c;
5800 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5801 @end smallexample
5802
5803 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5804 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5805 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5806 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5807 be something like:
5808
5809 @smallexample
5810 int foo (void)
5811 @{
5812 register int *xr = &x;
5813 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5814 @}
5815 @end smallexample
5816
5817 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5818 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5819
5820 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5821 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5822 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5823 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5824
5825 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5826 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5827 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5828 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5829 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5830 @end deftypevr
5831
5832 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5833 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5834 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5835 value is 0.
5836 @end deftypevr
5837
5838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5839 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5840 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5841 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5842 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5843
5844 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5845 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5846 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5847 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5848 @end deftypefn
5849
5850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5851 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5852 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5853 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5854
5855 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5856 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5857 or target-specific sections.
5858 @end deftypefn
5859
5860 @node Condition Code
5861 @section Condition Code Status
5862 @cindex condition code status
5863
5864 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5865 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5866
5867 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5868 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5869 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5870 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5871 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5872 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5873 most RISC machines.
5874
5875 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5876 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5877 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5878 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5879 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5880 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5881 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5882 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5883
5884 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5885 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5886 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5887 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5888 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5889 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5890 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5891
5892 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5893 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5894 interested in most macros in this section.
5895
5896 @menu
5897 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5898 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5899 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5900 @end menu
5901
5902 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5903 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5904 @findex cc0
5905
5906 @findex cc_status
5907 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5908 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5909 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5910 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5911 currently based, and several standard flags.
5912
5913 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5914 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5915 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5916
5917 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5918 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5919 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5920
5921 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5922 @end defmac
5923
5924 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5925 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5926 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5927 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5928 define this macro to initialize it.
5929
5930 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5931 @end defmac
5932
5933 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5934 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5935 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5936 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5937 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5938 set @code{(cc0)}.
5939
5940 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5941
5942 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5943 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5944 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5945 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5946 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5947 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5948 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5949 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5950 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5951 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5952 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5953 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5954 condition code value.
5955
5956 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5957 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5958 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5959 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5960 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5961 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5962 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5963
5964 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5965 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5966 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5967 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5968 @end defmac
5969
5970 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5971 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5972 @findex CCmode
5973 @findex MODE_CC
5974
5975 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5976 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5977 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5978 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5979 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5980 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5981 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5982 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5983 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5984 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5985 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5986
5987 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5988 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5989 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5990 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5991 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5992 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5993 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 (define_insn ""
5997 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5998 (compare:CC_NOOV
5999 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6000 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6001 (const_int 0)))]
6002 ""
6003 "@dots{}")
6004 @end smallexample
6005
6006 @noindent
6007 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6008 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6009
6010 @smallexample
6011 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6012 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6013 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6014 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6015 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6016 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6017 @end smallexample
6018
6019 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6020 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6021 this section.
6022
6023 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6024 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6025 @end defmac
6026
6027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value}) (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1}, @var{op0_preserve_value})
6028 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6029 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6030 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6031 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6032
6033 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6034 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6035 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6036 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6037 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6038 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6039 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6040
6041 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6042 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6043 @file{md} file.
6044
6045 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6046 comparison code or operands.
6047 @end deftypefn
6048
6049 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6050 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6051 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6052 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6053 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6054
6055 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6056 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6057 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6058 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6059
6060 @smallexample
6061 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6062 @end smallexample
6063 @end defmac
6064
6065 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6066 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6067 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6068 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6069 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6070 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6071 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6072 like:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6076 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6077 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6078 @end smallexample
6079 @end defmac
6080
6081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6082 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6083 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6084 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6085 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6086 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6087 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6088 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6089 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6090 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6091 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6092
6093 The default version of this hook returns false.
6094 @end deftypefn
6095
6096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (enum machine_mode @var{m1}, enum machine_mode @var{m2})
6097 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6098 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6099 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6100 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6101 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6102 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6103
6104 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6105 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6106 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6107 @end deftypefn
6108
6109 @node Cond Exec Macros
6110 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6111 @findex conditional execution
6112 @findex predication
6113
6114 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6115 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6116 represent conditional branches.
6117
6118 @node Costs
6119 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6120 @cindex costs of instructions
6121 @cindex relative costs
6122 @cindex speed of instructions
6123
6124 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6125 on the target machine.
6126
6127 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6128 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6129 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6130 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6131 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6132 that.
6133
6134 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6135 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6136 registers if they are not general registers.
6137
6138 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6139 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6140 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6141 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6142 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6143 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6144
6145 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6146 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6147 @end defmac
6148
6149 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6150 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6151 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6152 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6153 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6154 that.
6155
6156 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6157 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6158 registers if they are not general registers.
6159
6160 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6161 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6162 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6163 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6164 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6165 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6166
6167 The default version of this function returns 2.
6168 @end deftypefn
6169
6170 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6171 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6172 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6173 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6174 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6175 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6176 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6177
6178 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6179 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6180 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6181 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6182 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6183 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6184
6185 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6186 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6187 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6188 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6189 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6190 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6191 are the same as to this macro.
6192
6193 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6194 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6195 @end defmac
6196
6197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6198 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6199 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6200 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6201 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6202 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6203 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6204
6205 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6206 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6207 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6208 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6209 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6210 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6211
6212 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6213 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6214 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6215 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6216 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6217 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6218 are the same as to this target hook.
6219 @end deftypefn
6220
6221 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6222 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6223 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6224 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6225 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6226 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6227 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6228 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6229 @end defmac
6230
6231 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6232 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6233 ordinarily expect.
6234
6235 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6236 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6237 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6238 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6239 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6240 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6241
6242 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6243 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6244 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6245 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6246 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6247 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6248 @end defmac
6249
6250 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6251 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6252 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6253 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6254 handler.
6255
6256 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6257 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6258 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6259 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6260 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6261
6262 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6263 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6264 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6265 @end defmac
6266
6267 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6268 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6269 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6270 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6271 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6272
6273 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6274 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6275 the number of such sequences.
6276
6277 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6278 optimized for speed rather than size.
6279
6280 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6281 @end defmac
6282
6283 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6284 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6285 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6286 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6287 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6288 @end defmac
6289
6290 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6291 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6292 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6293 @end defmac
6294
6295 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6296 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6297 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6298 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6299 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6300
6301 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6302 optimized for speed rather than size.
6303
6304 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6305 @end defmac
6306
6307 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6308 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6309 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6310 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6311 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6312 @end defmac
6313
6314 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6315 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6316 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6317 a block set insn or a library call.
6318 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6319 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6320
6321 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6322 optimized for speed rather than size.
6323
6324 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6325 @end defmac
6326
6327 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6328 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6329 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6330 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6331 storing values other than constant zero.
6332 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6333 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6334 @end defmac
6335
6336 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6337 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6338 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6339 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6340 called with a constant source string.
6341 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6342 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6343 @end defmac
6344
6345 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6346 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6347 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6348 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6349 @end defmac
6350
6351 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6352 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6353 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6354 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6355 @end defmac
6356
6357 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6358 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6359 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6360 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6361 @end defmac
6362
6363 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6364 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6365 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6366 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6367 @end defmac
6368
6369 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6370 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6371 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6372 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6373 @end defmac
6374
6375 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6376 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6377 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6378 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6379 @end defmac
6380
6381 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6382 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6383 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6384 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6385 @end defmac
6386
6387 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6388 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6389 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6390 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6391 @end defmac
6392
6393 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6394 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6395 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6396 @end defmac
6397
6398 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6399 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6400 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6401 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6402 @end defmac
6403
6404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6405 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6406
6407 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6408 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6409 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6410 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6411 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6412 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6413 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6414
6415 @var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6416 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6417
6418 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6419 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6420 instructions.
6421
6422 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6423 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6424 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6425 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6426 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6427
6428 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6429 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6430 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6431
6432 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6433 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6434 @end deftypefn
6435
6436 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6437 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6438 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6439 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6440
6441 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6442 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6443 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6444 all addresses will have equal costs.
6445
6446 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6447 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6448 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6449
6450 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6451 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6452 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6453 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6454 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6455 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6456 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6457 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6458
6459 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6460
6461 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6462 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6463 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6464 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6465 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6466 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6467 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6468 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6469 @end deftypefn
6470
6471 @node Scheduling
6472 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6473
6474 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6475 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6476 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6477 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6478
6479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6480 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6481 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6482 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6483 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6484 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6485 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6486 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6487 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6488 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6489 @end deftypefn
6490
6491 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
6492 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6493 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6494 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6495 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6496 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6497 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6498 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6499 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6500 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6501 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6502 was scheduled.
6503 @end deftypefn
6504
6505 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6506 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6507 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6508 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6509 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6510 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6511 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6512 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6513 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6514 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6515 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6516 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6517 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6518 @end deftypefn
6519
6520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6521 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6522 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6523 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6524 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6525 scheduling priorities of insns.
6526 @end deftypefn
6527
6528 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6529 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6530 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6531 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6532 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6533 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6534 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6535 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6536 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6537 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6538 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6539 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6540 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6541 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6542 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6543 @end deftypefn
6544
6545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6546 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6547 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6548 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6549 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6550 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6551 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6552 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6553 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6554 @end deftypefn
6555
6556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
6557 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6558 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6559 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6560 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6561 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6562 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6563 calculated.
6564 @end deftypefn
6565
6566 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6567 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6568 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6569 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6570 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6571 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6572 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6573 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6574 @end deftypefn
6575
6576 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6577 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6578 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6579 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6580 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6581 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6582 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6583 @end deftypefn
6584
6585 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6586 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6587 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6588 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6589 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6590 @end deftypefn
6591
6592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6593 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6594 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6595 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6596 @end deftypefn
6597
6598 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6599 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6600 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6601 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6602 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6603 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6604 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6605 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6606 @end deftypefn
6607
6608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6609 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6610 @end deftypefn
6611
6612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6613 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6614 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6615 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6616 @end deftypefn
6617
6618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6619 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6620 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6621 @end deftypefn
6622
6623 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6624 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6625 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6626 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6627 state on a single insn is not enough.
6628 @end deftypefn
6629
6630 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6631 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6632 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6633 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6634 state on a single insn is not enough.
6635 @end deftypefn
6636
6637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6638 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6639 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6640 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6641 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6642 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6643 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6644 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6645 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6646 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6647 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6648
6649 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6650 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6651 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6652 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6653 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6654 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6655 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6656 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6657 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6658
6659 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6660 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6661 schedules to choose the best one.
6662
6663 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6664 @end deftypefn
6665
6666 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx @var{insn})
6667
6668 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6669 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6670 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6671 be issued.
6672
6673 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6674 @end deftypefn
6675
6676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6677 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6678 scheduling.
6679 @end deftypefn
6680
6681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx @var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6682 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6683 @end deftypefn
6684
6685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6686 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6687 an instruction.
6688 @end deftypefn
6689
6690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6691 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6692 round of multipass scheduling.
6693 @end deftypefn
6694
6695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6696 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6697 @end deftypefn
6698
6699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6700 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6701 @end deftypefn
6702
6703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6704 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6705 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6706 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6707 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6708 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6709 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6710 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6711 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6712 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6713 and the current processor cycle.
6714 @end deftypefn
6715
6716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6717 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6718 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6719 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6720 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6721 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6722 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6723 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6724 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6725 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6726 and @code{false} otherwise.
6727
6728 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6729 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6730 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6731 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6732 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6733 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6734 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6735 @end deftypefn
6736
6737 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6738 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6739 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6740 per instruction data structures.
6741 @end deftypefn
6742
6743 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6744 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6745 @end deftypefn
6746
6747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6748 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6749 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6750 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6751 @end deftypefn
6752
6753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6754 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6755 @end deftypefn
6756
6757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6758 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6759 @end deftypefn
6760
6761 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6762 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6763 @end deftypefn
6764
6765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{request}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6766 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6767 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6768 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6769 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6770 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6771 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6772 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6773 the generated speculative pattern.
6774 @end deftypefn
6775
6776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (int @var{dep_status})
6777 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6778 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6779 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6780 @end deftypefn
6781
6782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{label}, int @var{mutate_p})
6783 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6784 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6785 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6786 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6787 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6788 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6789 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6790 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6791 @end deftypefn
6792
6793 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC (const_rtx @var{insn})
6794 This hook is used as a workaround for
6795 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6796 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6797 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6798 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6799 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6800 For non-speculative instructions,
6801 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6802 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6803 is nearly full.
6804 @end deftypefn
6805
6806 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6807 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6808 enabled/used.
6809 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6810 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6811 @end deftypefn
6812
6813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6814 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6815 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6816 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6817 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6818 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6819 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6820 @end deftypefn
6821
6822 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6823 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6824 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6825 @end deftypefn
6826
6827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{x})
6828 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6829 in its second parameter.
6830 @end deftypefn
6831
6832 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6833 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6834 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6835 also the latencies of operations.
6836 @end deftypevr
6837
6838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
6839 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6840 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6841 @end deftypefn
6842
6843 @node Sections
6844 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6845 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6846 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6847
6848 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6849 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6850 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6851 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6852 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6853 of sections.
6854
6855 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6856 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6857 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6858 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6859 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6860 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6861 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6862
6863 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6864 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6865 to be string literals.
6866
6867 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6868 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6869 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6870 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6871
6872 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6873 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6874 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6875 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6876 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6877 reuse @code{text_section}.
6878
6879 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6880 if the target does not provide them.
6881
6882 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6883 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6884 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6885 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6886 @end defmac
6887
6888 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6889 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6890 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6891 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6892 @end defmac
6893
6894 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6895 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6896 executed functions in the program.
6897 @end defmac
6898
6899 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6900 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6901 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6902 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6903 @end defmac
6904
6905 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6906 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908 initialized, writable small data.
6909 @end defmac
6910
6911 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6912 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6913 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6914 data.
6915 @end defmac
6916
6917 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6918 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6919 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6920 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6921 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6922 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6923 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6924 used.
6925 @end defmac
6926
6927 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6928 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6929 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6930 uninitialized, writable small data.
6931 @end defmac
6932
6933 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6934 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6935 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6936 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6937 @end defmac
6938
6939 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6940 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6941 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6942 default is @code{'T'}.
6943 @end defmac
6944
6945 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6946 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6947 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6948 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6949 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6950 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6951 @end defmac
6952
6953 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6954 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6955 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6956 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6957 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6958 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6959 @end defmac
6960
6961 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6962 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6963 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6964 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6965 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6966 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6967 @end defmac
6968
6969 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6970 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6971 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6972 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6973 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6974 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6975 @end defmac
6976
6977 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6978 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6979 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6980 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6981 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6982 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6983 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6984 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6985 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6986 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6987 @end defmac
6988
6989 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6990 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6991 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6992 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6993 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6994 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6995 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6996 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6997 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6998 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6999 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7000 @end defmac
7001
7002 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7003 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7004 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7005 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7006 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7007 @end defmac
7008
7009 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7010 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7011 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7012 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7013 readonly data section is used.
7014
7015 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7016 @end defmac
7017
7018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7019 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7020 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7021 of its own that you need to create.
7022
7023 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7024 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7025 described below.
7026 @end deftypefn
7027
7028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7029 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7030 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7031 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7032 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7033
7034 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7035 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7036 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7037 in read-only sections even in executables.
7038 @end deftypefn
7039
7040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7041 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7042 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7043 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7044 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7045 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7046 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7047
7048 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7049 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7050
7051 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7052 @end deftypefn
7053
7054 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7055 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7056 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7057
7058 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7059 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7060 it is unlikely to be called.
7061 @end defmac
7062
7063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7064 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7065 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7066 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7067 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7068
7069 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7070 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7071 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7072 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7073 @end deftypefn
7074
7075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7076 Return the readonly data section associated with
7077 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7078 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7079 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7080 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7081 otherwise.
7082 @end deftypefn
7083
7084 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7085 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7086 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7087 the string if a different section name should be used.
7088 @end deftypevr
7089
7090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7091 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7092 @end deftypefn
7093
7094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7095 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7096 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7097 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7098 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7099 in bits.
7100
7101 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7102 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7103 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7104 @end deftypefn
7105
7106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7107 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7108 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7109 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7110 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7111 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7112 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7113 returns the @var{id} provided.
7114 @end deftypefn
7115
7116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7117 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7118 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7119 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7120
7121 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7122 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7123 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7124 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7125 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7126
7127 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7128 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7129 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7130 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7131 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7132 leave it alone.)
7133
7134 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7135 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7136 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7137 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7138 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7139 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7140
7141 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7142 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7143 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7144 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7145 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7146 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7147
7148 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7149 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7150 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7151 before overriding it.
7152 @end deftypefn
7153
7154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7155 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7156 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7157 may have added.
7158 @end deftypefn
7159
7160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7161 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7162 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7163 @end deftypefn
7164
7165 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7166 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7167 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7168 @end deftypevr
7169
7170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7171 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7172
7173 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7174 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7175 @end deftypefn
7176
7177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7178 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7179 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7180 or executable image).
7181
7182 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7183 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7184 currently supported object file formats.
7185 @end deftypefn
7186
7187 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7188 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7189 The default value is false.
7190 @end deftypevr
7191
7192
7193 @node PIC
7194 @section Position Independent Code
7195 @cindex position independent code
7196 @cindex PIC
7197
7198 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7199 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7200 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7201 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7202 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7203 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7204 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7205 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7206 relative addresses.
7207 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7208 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7209
7210 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7211 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7212 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7213 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7214 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7215 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7216 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7217 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7218 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7219 @end defmac
7220
7221 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7222 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7223 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7224 the default is zero. Do not define
7225 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7226 @end defmac
7227
7228 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7229 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7230 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7231 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7232 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7233 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7234 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7235 position independent code.
7236 @end defmac
7237
7238 @node Assembler Format
7239 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7240
7241 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7242 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7243 instructions do.
7244
7245 @menu
7246 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7247 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7248 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7249 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7250 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7251 and termination routines.
7252 * Macros for Initialization::
7253 Specific macros that control the handling of
7254 initialization and termination routines.
7255 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7256 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7257 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7258 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7259 @end menu
7260
7261 @node File Framework
7262 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7263 @cindex assembler format
7264 @cindex output of assembler code
7265
7266 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7267 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7268
7269 @findex default_file_start
7270 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7271 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7272 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7273 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7274 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7275 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7276 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7277 @end deftypefn
7278
7279 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7280 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7281 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7282 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7283 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7284 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7285 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7286 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7287
7288 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7289 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7290 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7291 @end deftypevr
7292
7293 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7294 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7295 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7296 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7297 this to be done. The default is false.
7298 @end deftypevr
7299
7300 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7301 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7302 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7303 @end deftypefn
7304
7305 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7306 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7307 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7308 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7309 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7310 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7311 this function.
7312 @end deftypefun
7313
7314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7315 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7316 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7317 nothing.
7318 @end deftypefn
7319
7320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7321 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7322 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7323 nothing.
7324 @end deftypefn
7325
7326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7327 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7328 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7329 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7330 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7331 nothing.
7332 @end deftypefn
7333
7334 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7335 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7336 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7337 the end of the line.
7338 @end defmac
7339
7340 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7341 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7342 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7343 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7344 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7345 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7346 @end defmac
7347
7348 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7349 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7350 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7351 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7352 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7353 @end defmac
7354
7355 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7356 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7357 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7358 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7359
7360 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7361 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7362 @end defmac
7363
7364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7365 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7366
7367 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7368 @end deftypefn
7369
7370 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7371 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7372 @end deftypefn
7373
7374 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7375 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7376 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7377 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7378 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7379 of the filename using this macro.
7380 @end defmac
7381
7382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7383 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7384 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7385 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7386 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7387 this section is associated.
7388 @end deftypefn
7389
7390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7391 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7392 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7393 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7394 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7395 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7396 (from static destructors).
7397 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7398 @end deftypefn
7399
7400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7401 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7402 @end deftypefn
7403
7404 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7405 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7406 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7407 @end deftypevr
7408
7409 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7410 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7411 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7412 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7413 This is true on most ELF targets.
7414 @end deftypevr
7415
7416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7417 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7418 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7419 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7420 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7421
7422 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7423 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7424 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7425 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7426 @end deftypefn
7427
7428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7429 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7430 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7431 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7432 It can take the following values:
7433
7434 @table @gcctabopt
7435 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7436 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7437
7438 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7439 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7440 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7441 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7442 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7443 various different individual optimization passes.
7444
7445 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7446 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7447 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7448 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7449 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7450 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7451 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7452 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7453 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7454 switches.
7455
7456 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7457 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7458
7459 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7460 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7461 @end table
7462
7463 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7464 supported in the future.
7465
7466 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7467 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7468 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7469 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7470 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7471 hook.
7472 @end deftypefn
7473
7474 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7475 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7476 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7477 hook.
7478 @end deftypevr
7479
7480 @need 2000
7481 @node Data Output
7482 @subsection Output of Data
7483
7484
7485 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7486 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7487 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7488 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7489 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7490 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7491 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7492 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7493 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7494 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7495 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7496 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7497 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7498 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7499
7500 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7501 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7502 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7503 @end deftypevr
7504
7505 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7506 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7507 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7508 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7509 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7510 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7511 split the object into smaller parts.
7512
7513 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7514 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7515 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7516 @end deftypefn
7517
7518 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7519 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7520 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7521 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7522 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7523
7524 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7525 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7526 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7527 return @code{true}.
7528 @end deftypefn
7529
7530 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7531 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7532 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7533 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7534 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7535
7536 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7537 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7538 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7539 @end defmac
7540
7541 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7542 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7543 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7544 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7545 @end defmac
7546
7547 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7548 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7549 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7550 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7551 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7552 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7553 pool before the function.
7554 @end defmac
7555
7556 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7557 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7558 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7559 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7560 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7561 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7562 immediately after this call.
7563
7564 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7565 not be defined.
7566 @end defmac
7567
7568 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7569 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7570 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7571 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7572
7573 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7574 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7575 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7576 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7577 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7578 alignment.
7579
7580 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7581 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7582 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7583 Here is how to do this:
7584
7585 @smallexample
7586 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7587 @end smallexample
7588
7589 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7590 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7591 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7592
7593 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7594 @end defmac
7595
7596 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7597 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7598 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7599 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7600 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7601 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7602
7603 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7604 define this macro.
7605 @end defmac
7606
7607 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7608 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7609 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7610 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7611 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7612
7613 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7614 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7615 @end defmac
7616
7617 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7618 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7619 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7620 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7621 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7622 @end deftypevr
7623
7624 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7625 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7626
7627 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7628 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7629 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7630 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7631 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7632 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7633 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7634 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7635 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7636 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7637 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7638 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7639 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7640 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7641 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7642 on the host machine.
7643
7644 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7645 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7646 machine's memory.
7647 @end defmac
7648
7649 @node Uninitialized Data
7650 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7651
7652 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7653 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7654
7655 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7656 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7657 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7658 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7659 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7660 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7661 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7662 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7663 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7664 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7665 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7666 an ordinary undefined external.
7667
7668 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7669 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7670 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7671
7672 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7673 common global variables are output.
7674 @end defmac
7675
7676 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7677 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7678 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7679 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7680 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7681 as the number of bits.
7682 @end defmac
7683
7684 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7685 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7686 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7687 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7688 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7689 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7690 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7691 @end defmac
7692
7693 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7694 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7695 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7696 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7697 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7698
7699 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7700 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7701 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7702 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7703 the name, and a newline.
7704
7705 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7706 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7707 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7708 You do not need to do both.
7709
7710 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7711 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7712 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7713 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7714 common in order to save space in the object file.
7715 @end defmac
7716
7717 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7718 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7719 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7720 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7721 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7722
7723 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7724 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7725 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7726
7727 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7728 static variables are output.
7729 @end defmac
7730
7731 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7732 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7733 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7734 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7735 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7736 as the number of bits.
7737 @end defmac
7738
7739 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7740 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7741 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7742 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7743 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7744 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7745 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7746 @end defmac
7747
7748 @node Label Output
7749 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7750
7751 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7752 This is about outputting labels.
7753
7754 @findex assemble_name
7755 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7756 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7757 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7758 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7759 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7760 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7761 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7762 @end defmac
7763
7764 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7765 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7766 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7767 a function.
7768 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7769 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7770 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7771 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7772
7773 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7774 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7775 @end defmac
7776
7777 @findex assemble_name_raw
7778 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7779 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7780 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7781 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7782 that it is more efficient.
7783 @end defmac
7784
7785 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7786 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7787 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7788 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7789 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7790
7791 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7792 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7793 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7794 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7795 define this macro.
7796 @end defmac
7797
7798 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7799 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7800 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7801 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7802 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7803 provided.
7804 @end defmac
7805
7806 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7807 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7808 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7809 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7810 address.
7811
7812 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7813 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7814 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7815 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7816 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7817 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7821 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7822 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7823 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7824 @samp{.} is used instead.
7825 @end defmac
7826
7827 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7828 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7829 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7830 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7831 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7832 @end defmac
7833
7834 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7835 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7836 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7837 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7838 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7839
7840 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7841 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7842 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7843 types at all, do not define this macro.
7844 @end defmac
7845
7846 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7847 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7848 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7849 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7850 the default is not to define this macro.
7851
7852 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7853 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7854 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7855 types at all, do not define this macro.
7856 @end defmac
7857
7858 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7859 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7860 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7861 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7862 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7863 you should not count on this.
7864
7865 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7866 definition of this macro is provided.
7867 @end defmac
7868
7869 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7870 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7871 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7872 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7873 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7874 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7875 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7876
7877 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7878 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7879
7880 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7881 of this macro.
7882 @end defmac
7883
7884 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7885 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7886 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7887 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7888 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7889 representing the function.
7890
7891 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7892
7893 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7894 of this macro.
7895 @end defmac
7896
7897 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7898 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7899 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7900 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7901 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7902 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7903
7904 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7905 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7906
7907 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7908 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7909 @end defmac
7910
7911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7912 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7913 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7914 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7915 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7916 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7917 will be an internal label.
7918
7919 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7920 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7921
7922 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7923 @end deftypefn
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7928 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7929
7930 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7931 nothing.
7932 @end defmac
7933
7934 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7935 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7936 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7937 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7938 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7939 something about the size of the object.
7940
7941 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7942 nothing.
7943
7944 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7945 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7946 @end defmac
7947
7948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
7949 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7950 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7951 that is, available for reference from other files.
7952
7953 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7954 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7955 @end deftypefn
7956
7957 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
7958 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7959 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7960 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7961
7962 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7963 @end deftypefn
7964
7965 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7966 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7967 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7968 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7969 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7970 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7971 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7972 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7973
7974 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7975 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7976 macro.
7977 @end defmac
7978
7979 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7980 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7981 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7982 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7983 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7984 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7985 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7986 to make @var{name} weak.
7987 @end defmac
7988
7989 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7990 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7991 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7992 declaration of @code{name}.
7993 @end defmac
7994
7995 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7996 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7997 supports weak symbols.
7998
7999 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8000 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8001 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8002 @end defmac
8003
8004 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8005 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8006
8007 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8008 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8009 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8010 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8011 @end defmac
8012
8013 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8014 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8015 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8016 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8017 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8018 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8019 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8020 @end defmac
8021
8022 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8023 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8024 semantics.
8025
8026 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8027 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8028 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8029 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8030 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8031 be emitted as one-only.
8032 @end defmac
8033
8034 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8035 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8036 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8037 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8038 @end deftypefn
8039
8040 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8041 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8042 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8043 The default is @code{0}.
8044
8045 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8046 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8047 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8048 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8049 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8050 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8051 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8052
8053 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8054 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8055 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8056 table of contents.
8057 @end defmac
8058
8059 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8060 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8061 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8062 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8063 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8064 declaration.
8065
8066 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8067 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8068 @end defmac
8069
8070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8071 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8072 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8073 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8074 @end deftypefn
8075
8076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8077 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8078 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8079 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8080 @end deftypefn
8081
8082 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8083 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8084 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8085 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8086 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8087 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8088 @end defmac
8089
8090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8091 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8092 @end deftypefn
8093
8094 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8095 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8096 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8097 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8098 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8099 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8100 @end defmac
8101
8102 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8103 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8104 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8105 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8106 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8107 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8108 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8109 being taken.
8110 @end defmac
8111
8112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8113 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8114 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8115
8116 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8117 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8118 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8119
8120 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8121 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8122 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8123 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8124 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8125
8126 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8127 @end deftypefn
8128
8129 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8130 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8131 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8132 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8133 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8134 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8135 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8136 bundles.
8137
8138 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8139 used.
8140 @end defmac
8141
8142 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8143 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8144 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8145
8146 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8147 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8148 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8149
8150 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8151 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8152 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8153 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8154 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8155 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8156 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8157 @end defmac
8158
8159 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8160 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8161 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8162 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8163 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8164
8165 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8166 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8167 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8168 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8169 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8170 internal static variables in different scopes.
8171
8172 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8173 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8174 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8175 between the name and the number will suffice.
8176
8177 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8178 which is correct for most systems.
8179 @end defmac
8180
8181 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8182 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8183 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8184
8185 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8186 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8187 correct for most systems.
8188 @end defmac
8189
8190 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8191 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8192 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8193 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8194 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8195 the tree nodes are available.
8196
8197 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8198 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8199 correct for most systems.
8200 @end defmac
8201
8202 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8203 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8204 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8205 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8206 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8207 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8208 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8209 @end defmac
8210
8211 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8212 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8213 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8214 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8215 an undefined weak symbol.
8216
8217 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8218 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8219 @end defmac
8220
8221 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8222 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8223 Objective-C methods.
8224
8225 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8226 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8227 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8228 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8229
8230 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8231 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8232 systems define other ways of computing names.
8233
8234 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8235 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8236 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8237 50 characters extra.
8238
8239 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8240 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8241 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8242 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8243
8244 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8245 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8246 @end defmac
8247
8248 @node Initialization
8249 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8250 @cindex initialization routines
8251 @cindex termination routines
8252 @cindex constructors, output of
8253 @cindex destructors, output of
8254
8255 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8256 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8257 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8258 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8259 @code{main} is called.
8260
8261 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8262 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8263 terminates.
8264
8265 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8266 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8267 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8268 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8269
8270 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8271 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8272 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8273
8274 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8275 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8276 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8277 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8278 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8279
8280 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8281 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8282 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8283 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8284 pointer containing zero.
8285
8286 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8287 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8288 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8289 list; destructors in forward order.
8290
8291 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8292 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8293 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8294 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8295 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8296 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8297 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8298 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8299
8300 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8301 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8302 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8303 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8304 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8305
8306 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8307 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8308 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8309 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8310 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8311
8312 @smallexample
8313 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8314 @end smallexample
8315
8316 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8317 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8318 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8319 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8320 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8321
8322 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8323 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8324 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8325 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8326 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8327 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8328
8329 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8330 macro properly.
8331
8332 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8333 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8334 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8335 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8336 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8337 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8338
8339 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8340 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8341 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8342 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8343 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8344 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8345 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8346 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8347 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8348 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8349 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8350 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8351 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8352 the initialization process.
8353
8354 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8355 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8356 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8357 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8358 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8359 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8360 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8361 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8362 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8363 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8364 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8365
8366 @ifinfo
8367 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8368 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8369 @end ifinfo
8370
8371 @node Macros for Initialization
8372 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8373
8374 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8375 and termination functions:
8376
8377 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8378 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8379 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8380 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8381 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8382 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8383 run the initialization functions.
8384 @end defmac
8385
8386 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8387 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8388 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8389 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8390 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8391 @end defmac
8392
8393 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8394 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8395 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8396 @end defmac
8397
8398 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8399 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8400 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8401 @end defmac
8402
8403 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8404 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8405 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8406 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8407 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8408 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8409
8410 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8411 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8412 exception tables embedded in the code.
8413 @end defmac
8414
8415 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8416 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8417 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8418 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8419 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8420 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8421 @end defmac
8422
8423 @defmac INVOKE__main
8424 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8425 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8426 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8427 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8428 @end defmac
8429
8430 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8431 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8432 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8433 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8434 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8435 @end defmac
8436
8437 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8438 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8439 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8440 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8441 @end deftypevr
8442
8443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8444 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8445 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8446
8447 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8448 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8449 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8450 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8451
8452 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8453 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8454 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8455 is not defined.
8456 @end deftypefn
8457
8458 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8459 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8460 functions rather than initialization functions.
8461 @end deftypefn
8462
8463 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8464 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8465
8466 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8467 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8468 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8469
8470 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8471 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8472
8473 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8474 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8475 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8476 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8477
8478 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8479 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8480 @end defmac
8481
8482 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8483 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8484 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8485 @command{nm}.
8486 @end defmac
8487
8488 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8489 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8490 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8491 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8492 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8493 produces.
8494 @end defmac
8495
8496 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8497 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8498 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8499 termination functions in shared libraries:
8500
8501 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8502 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8503 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8504 @end defmac
8505
8506 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8507 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8508 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8509 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8510 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8511 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8512 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8513 @end defmac
8514
8515 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8516 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8517 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8518 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8519 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8520 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8521 @end defmac
8522
8523 @node Instruction Output
8524 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8525
8526 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8527 This describes assembler instruction output.
8528
8529 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8530 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8531 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8532 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8533 @end defmac
8534
8535 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8536 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8537 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8538 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8539 to registers using alternate names.
8540 @end defmac
8541
8542 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8543 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8544 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8545 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8546 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8547 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8548 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8549 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8550
8551 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8552 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8553 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8554 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8555 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8556 @end defmac
8557
8558 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8559 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8560 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8561
8562 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8563 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8564 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8565 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8566 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8567 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8568 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8569 so that it will not be output twice.
8570
8571 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8572 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8573 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8574 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8575 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8576
8577 @findex recog_data.operand
8578 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8579 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8580
8581 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8582 in the usual way.
8583 @end defmac
8584
8585 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8586 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8587 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8588 they will be output differently.
8589
8590 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8591 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8592 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8593 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8594 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8595 by changing the contents of the vector.
8596
8597 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8598 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8599 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8600 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8601 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8602 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8603
8604 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8605 @end defmac
8606
8607 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8608 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8609 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8610 if necessary.
8611
8612 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8613 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8614 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8615 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8616 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8617 by checking the contents of the vector.
8618 @end deftypefn
8619
8620 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8621 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8622 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8623 RTL expression.
8624
8625 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8626 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8627 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8628 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8629 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8630 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8631 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8632
8633 @findex reg_names
8634 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8635 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8636 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8637 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8638
8639 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8640 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8641 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8642 @var{code}.
8643 @end defmac
8644
8645 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8646 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8647 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8648 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8649 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8650 in this way.
8651 @end defmac
8652
8653 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8654 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8655 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8656 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8657
8658 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8659 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8660 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8661 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8662 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8663 Format}.
8664 @end defmac
8665
8666 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8667 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8668 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8669 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8670 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8671 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8672 or whatever.
8673
8674 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8675 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8676 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8677 @end defmac
8678
8679 @findex final_sequence
8680 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8681 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8682 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8683 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8684 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8685 being output.
8686
8687 @findex asm_fprintf
8688 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8689 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8690 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8691 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8692 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8693 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8694 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8695 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8696 files can define these macros differently.
8697 @end defmac
8698
8699 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8700 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8701 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8702 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8703 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8704 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8705 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8706 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8707 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8708 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8709 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8710 @end defmac
8711
8712 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8713 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8714 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8715 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8716 first variant.
8717
8718 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8719 @smallexample
8720 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8721 @end smallexample
8722 @noindent
8723 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8724 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8725 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8726 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8727 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8728 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8729 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8730
8731 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8732 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8733 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8734
8735 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8736 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8737 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8738 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8739 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8740 opcodes or operand order.
8741 @end defmac
8742
8743 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8744 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8745 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8746 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8747 profiling.
8748 @end defmac
8749
8750 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8751 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8752 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8753 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8754 profiling.
8755 @end defmac
8756
8757 @node Dispatch Tables
8758 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8759
8760 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8761 This concerns dispatch tables.
8762
8763 @cindex dispatch table
8764 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8765 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8766 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8767 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8768 definitions of these labels are output using
8769 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8770 way here. For example,
8771
8772 @smallexample
8773 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8774 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8775 @end smallexample
8776
8777 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8778 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8779 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8780 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8781 mode and flags can be read.
8782 @end defmac
8783
8784 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8785 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8786 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8787
8788 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8789 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8790 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8791 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8792 For example,
8793
8794 @smallexample
8795 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8796 @end smallexample
8797 @end defmac
8798
8799 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8800 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8801 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8802 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8803 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8804 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8805
8806 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8807 for the table.
8808
8809 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8810 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8811 @end defmac
8812
8813 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8814 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8815 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8816 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8817 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8818 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8819 of the preceding label.
8820
8821 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8822 the jump-table.
8823 @end defmac
8824
8825 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8826 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8827 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8828 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8829 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8830 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8831 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8832 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8833
8834 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8835 @end deftypefn
8836
8837 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8838 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8839 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8840 to be broken up according to function.
8841
8842 The default is that no label is emitted.
8843 @end deftypefn
8844
8845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8846 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8847 @end deftypefn
8848
8849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx @var{insn})
8850 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8851 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8852 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8853 @end deftypefn
8854
8855 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8856 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8857 @end deftypevr
8858
8859 @node Exception Region Output
8860 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8861
8862 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8863
8864 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8865 region.
8866
8867 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8868 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8869 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8870 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8871 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8872
8873 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8874 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8875 @end defmac
8876
8877 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8878 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8879 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8880 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8881 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8882
8883 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8884 also defined.
8885 @end defmac
8886
8887 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8888 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8889 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8890 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8891 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8892 @end defmac
8893
8894 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8895 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8896 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8897 @end defmac
8898
8899 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8900 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8901 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8902 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8903 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8904 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8905 @end defmac
8906
8907 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8908 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8909 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8910 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8911 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8912 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8913 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8914
8915 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8916 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8917 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8918
8919 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8920 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8921 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8922 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8923 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8924 depending on this setting.
8925
8926 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8927 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8928 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8929 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8930 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8931 @end deftypefn
8932
8933 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8934 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8935 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8936 command-line option processing.
8937 @end deftypevr
8938
8939 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8940 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8941 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8942 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8943 @end defmac
8944
8945 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8946 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8947 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8948 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8949 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8950 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8951 @end defmac
8952
8953 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8954 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8955 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8956 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8957 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8958 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8959 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8960 @end defmac
8961
8962 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8963 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8964 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8965 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8966 true otherwise.
8967 @end deftypevr
8968
8969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
8970 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8971 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8972 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8973 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8974 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8975 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8976 @end deftypefn
8977
8978 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
8979 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8980 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8981 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8982 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8983 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8984 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8985 @end deftypefn
8986
8987 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
8988 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8989 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8990 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8991 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8992 @end deftypefn
8993
8994 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8995 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8996 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8997 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8998 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8999 @end deftypevr
9000
9001 @node Alignment Output
9002 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9003
9004 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9005 This describes commands for alignment.
9006
9007 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9008 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9009 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9010
9011 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9012 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9013 define the macro.
9014
9015 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9016 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9017 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9018 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9019 @end defmac
9020
9021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9022 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9023 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9024 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9025 @end deftypefn
9026
9027 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9028 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9029 a @code{BARRIER}.
9030
9031 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9032 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9033 define the macro.
9034 @end defmac
9035
9036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9037 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9038 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9039 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9040 @end deftypefn
9041
9042 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9043 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9044 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
9045
9046 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9047 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9048 define the macro.
9049
9050 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9051 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9052 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9053 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9054 @end defmac
9055
9056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9057 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9058 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9059 defined.
9060 @end deftypefn
9061
9062 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9063 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9064 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9065 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9066
9067 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9068 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9069 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9070 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9071 @end defmac
9072
9073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx @var{label})
9074 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9075 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9076 is defined.
9077 @end deftypefn
9078
9079 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9080 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9081 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9082 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9083 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9084 @end defmac
9085
9086 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9087 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9088 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9089 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9090 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9091 section.
9092 @end defmac
9093
9094 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9095 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9096 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9097 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9098 @end defmac
9099
9100 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9101 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9102 for padding, if necessary.
9103 @end defmac
9104
9105 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9106 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9107 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9108 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9109 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9110 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9111 @end defmac
9112
9113 @need 3000
9114 @node Debugging Info
9115 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9116
9117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9118 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9119
9120 @menu
9121 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9122 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9123 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9124 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9125 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9126 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9127 @end menu
9128
9129 @node All Debuggers
9130 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9131
9132 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9133 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9134
9135 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9136 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9137 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9138 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9139 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9140 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9141 compiler and another for DBX@.
9142
9143 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9144 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9145 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9146 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9147 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9148
9149 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9150 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9151 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9152 @end defmac
9153
9154 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9155 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9156 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9157 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9158 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9159 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9160 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9161 @option{-g} options is used.
9162 @end defmac
9163
9164 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9165 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9166 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9167 @var{offset}.
9168 @end defmac
9169
9170 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9171 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9172 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9173 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9174 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9175 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9176 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9177
9178 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9179 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9180 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9181 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9182 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9183
9184 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9185 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9186 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9187 @end defmac
9188
9189 @node DBX Options
9190 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9191
9192 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9193 These are specific options for DBX output.
9194
9195 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9196 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9197 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9198 @end defmac
9199
9200 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9201 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9202 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9203 @end defmac
9204
9205 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9206 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9207 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9208 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9209 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9210 if there is any occasion to.
9211 @end defmac
9212
9213 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9214 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9215 in the text section.
9216 @end defmac
9217
9218 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9219 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9220 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9221 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9222 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9223 @end defmac
9224
9225 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9226 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9227 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9228 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9229 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9230 information format.
9231 @end defmac
9232
9233 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9234 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9235 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9236 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9237 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9238 @end defmac
9239
9240 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9241 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9242 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9243 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9244 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9245 @end defmac
9246
9247 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9248 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9249 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9250 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9251 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9252 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9253 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9254 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9255 @end defmac
9256
9257 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9258 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9259 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9260 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9261 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9262 if backslash is correct for your system.
9263 @end defmac
9264
9265 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9266 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9267 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9268 variable.
9269 @end defmac
9270
9271 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9272 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9273 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9274 @end defmac
9275
9276 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9277 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9278 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9279 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9280 @end defmac
9281
9282 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9283 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9284 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9285 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9286 @end defmac
9287
9288 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9289 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9290 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9291 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9292 @end defmac
9293
9294 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9295 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9296 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9297 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9298 code.
9299 @end defmac
9300
9301 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9302 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9303 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9304 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9305 an absolute address.
9306 @end defmac
9307
9308 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9309 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9310 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9311 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9312 @end defmac
9313
9314 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9315 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9316 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9317 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9318 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9319 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9320 number for a type number.
9321 @end defmac
9322
9323 @node DBX Hooks
9324 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9325
9326 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9327 These are hooks for DBX format.
9328
9329 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9330 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9331 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9332 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9333 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9334 unique labels in the assembly output.
9335
9336 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9337 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9338 @end defmac
9339
9340 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9341 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9342 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9343 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9344 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9345 @end defmac
9346
9347 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9348 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9349 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9350 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9351 @end defmac
9352
9353 @node File Names and DBX
9354 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9355
9356 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9357 This describes file names in DBX format.
9358
9359 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9360 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9361 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9362 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9363 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9364
9365 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9366 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9367
9368 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9369 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9370 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9371 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9372 @end defmac
9373
9374 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9375 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9376 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9377 the beginning of the file.
9378 @end defmac
9379
9380 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9381 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9382 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9383 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9384 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9385 @end defmac
9386
9387 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9388 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9389 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9390 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9391
9392 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9393 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9394 @end defmac
9395
9396 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9397 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9398 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9399 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9400 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9401 @end defmac
9402
9403 @need 2000
9404 @node SDB and DWARF
9405 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9406
9407 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9408 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9409
9410 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9411 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9412 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9413 @end defmac
9414
9415 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9416 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9417 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9418
9419 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9420 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9421 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9422 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9423 @end deftypefn
9424
9425 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9426 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9427 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9428 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9429 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9430 @end defmac
9431
9432 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9433 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9434 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9435 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9436 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9437 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9438 @end defmac
9439
9440 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9441 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9442 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9443 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9444 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9445
9446 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9447 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9448
9449 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9450 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9451 @end deftypefn
9452
9453 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9454 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9455 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9456 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9457 @end defmac
9458
9459 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9460 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9461 @end deftypevr
9462
9463 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9464 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9465 @end deftypevr
9466
9467 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9468 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9469 @end deftypevr
9470
9471 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9472 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place. This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9473 @end deftypevr
9474
9475 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9476 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9477 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9478 @end defmac
9479
9480 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9481 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9482 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9483 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9484 @end defmac
9485
9486 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9487 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9488 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9489 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9490 @end defmac
9491
9492 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9493 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9494 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9495 @end defmac
9496
9497 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9498 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9499 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9500 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9501 is referenced by a function.
9502 @end defmac
9503
9504 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9505 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9506 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9507 @end deftypefn
9508
9509 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9510 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9511 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9512 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9513 not define them yourself.
9514 @end defmac
9515
9516 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9517 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9518 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9519 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9520 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9521 required.
9522 @end defmac
9523
9524 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9525 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9526 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9527 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9528 it.
9529 @end defmac
9530
9531 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9532 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9533 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9534 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9535 @end defmac
9536
9537 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9538 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9539 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9540 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9541 @end defmac
9542
9543 @need 2000
9544 @node VMS Debug
9545 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9546
9547 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9548 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9549
9550 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9551 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9552 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9553 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9554 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9555 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9556 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9557 @end defmac
9558
9559 @node Floating Point
9560 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9561 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9562 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9563
9564 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9565 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9566 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9567 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9568 doing the compilation.
9569
9570 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9571 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9572 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9573 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9574 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9575 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9576 target floating point formats are identical.
9577
9578 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9579 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9580 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9581 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9582
9583 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9584 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9585 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9586 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9587 quantity.
9588 @end defmac
9589
9590 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9591 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9592 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9593 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9594 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9595 @end deftypefn
9596
9597 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9598 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9599 @end deftypefn
9600
9601 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9602 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9603 @end deftypefn
9604
9605 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9606 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9607 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9608 @end deftypefn
9609
9610 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9611 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9612 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9613 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9614 defined by the C language for both.
9615 @end deftypefn
9616
9617 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9618 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9619 @end deftypefn
9620
9621 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9622 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9623 @end deftypefn
9624
9625 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9626 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9627 @end deftypefn
9628
9629 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9630 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9631 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9632 variable).
9633
9634 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9635 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9636 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9637
9638 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9639 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9640 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9641 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9642 @end deftypefn
9643
9644 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9645 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9646 @end deftypefn
9647
9648 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9649 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9650 @end deftypefn
9651
9652 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9653 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9654 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9655 integral, it is truncated.
9656 @end deftypefn
9657
9658 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9659 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9660 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9661 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9662 @end deftypefn
9663
9664 @node Mode Switching
9665 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9666 @cindex mode switching
9667 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9668
9669 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9670 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9671 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9672
9673 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9674 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9675 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9676 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9677 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9678 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9679 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9680
9681 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9682 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9683 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9684 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9685 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9686 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9687 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9688 are optional.
9689 @end defmac
9690
9691 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9692 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9693 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9694 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9695 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9696 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9697 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9698 entity in question.
9699 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9700 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9701 switch is needed / supplied.
9702 @end defmac
9703
9704 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9705 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9706 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9707 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9708 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9709 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9710 @end defmac
9711
9712 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9713 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9714 this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9715 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9716 different from the incoming mode).
9717 @end defmac
9718
9719 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9720 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9721 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9722 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9723 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9724 @end defmac
9725
9726 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9727 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9728 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9729 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9730 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9731 @end defmac
9732
9733 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9734 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9735 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9736 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9737 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9738 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9739 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9740 @end defmac
9741
9742 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9743 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9744 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9745 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9746 @end defmac
9747
9748 @node Target Attributes
9749 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9750 @cindex target attributes
9751 @cindex machine attributes
9752 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9753
9754 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9755 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9756 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9757
9758 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9759 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9760 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9761 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9762 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9763 take.
9764 @end deftypevr
9765
9766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9767 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9768 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9769 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9770 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9771 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9772 @end deftypefn
9773
9774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9775 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9776 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9777 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9778 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9779 supposed always to be compatible.
9780 @end deftypefn
9781
9782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9783 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9784 the newly defined @var{type}.
9785 @end deftypefn
9786
9787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9788 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9789 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9790 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9791 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9792 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9793 merging.
9794 @end deftypefn
9795
9796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9797 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9798 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9799 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9800 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9801 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9802 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9803 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9804
9805 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9806 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9807 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9808 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9809 will then define a function called
9810 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9811 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9812 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9813 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9814 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9815 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9816 @end deftypefn
9817
9818 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9819 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9820 @end deftypefn
9821
9822 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9823 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9824 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9825 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9826 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9827 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9828 on this implementation detail.
9829 @end defmac
9830
9831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9832 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9833 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9834 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9835 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9836 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9837 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9838 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9839 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9840 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9841 needed.
9842 @end deftypefn
9843
9844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9845 @cindex inlining
9846 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9847 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9848 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9849 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9850 @end deftypefn
9851
9852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9853 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9854 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9855 options for the current function that might be different than the
9856 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9857 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9858
9859 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9860 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9861 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9862 @end deftypefn
9863
9864 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9865 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9866 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9867 options.
9868 @xref{Option file format}.
9869 @end deftypefn
9870
9871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9872 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9873 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9874 function specific options.
9875 @end deftypefn
9876
9877 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9878 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9879 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9880 function specific options.
9881 @end deftypefn
9882
9883 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9884 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9885 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9886 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9887 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9888 @end deftypefn
9889
9890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9891 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9892 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9893 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9894 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9895
9896 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9897 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9898
9899 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9900 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9901 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9902 @end deftypefn
9903
9904 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9905 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9906 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9907 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9908 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9909 different target machines.
9910 @end deftypefn
9911
9912 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_SUPPORTS_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (void)
9913 This target hook returns @code{true} if the target supports function
9914 multiversioning.
9915 @end deftypefn
9916
9917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9918 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9919 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9920 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9921 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9922 @end deftypefn
9923
9924 @node Emulated TLS
9925 @section Emulating TLS
9926 @cindex Emulated TLS
9927
9928 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9929 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9930 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9931 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9932 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9933 layer.
9934
9935 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9936 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9937 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9938 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9939
9940 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9941 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9942 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9943 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9944 @end deftypevr
9945
9946 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9947 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9948 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9949 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9950 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9951 registration function to be used.
9952 @end deftypevr
9953
9954 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9955 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9956 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9957 any section.
9958 @end deftypevr
9959
9960 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9961 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9962 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9963 section.
9964 @end deftypevr
9965
9966 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9967 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9968 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9969 @end deftypevr
9970
9971 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9972 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9973 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9974 @end deftypevr
9975
9976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
9977 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9978 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9979 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9980 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9981 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9982 @end deftypefn
9983
9984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
9985 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9986 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9987 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9988 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9989 @end deftypefn
9990
9991 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9992 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9993 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9994 single objects. The default is false.
9995 @end deftypevr
9996
9997 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9998 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9999 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10000 @end deftypevr
10001
10002 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10003 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10004 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10005
10006 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10007 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10008 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10009 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10010
10011 @smallexample
10012 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10013 unsigned int d;
10014
10015 d = cp0count + 3;
10016 @end smallexample
10017
10018 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10019 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10020 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10021
10022 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10023 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10024 later in the function.
10025
10026 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10027 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10028 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10029
10030 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
10031 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
10032
10033 @node PCH Target
10034 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10035 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10036
10037 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10038 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10039 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10040 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10041 @end deftypefn
10042
10043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10044 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10045 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10046 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10047 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10048
10049 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10050 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10051 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10052 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10053
10054 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10055 suitable for most targets.
10056 @end deftypefn
10057
10058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10059 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10060 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10061 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10062 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10063 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10064 @end deftypefn
10065
10066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10067 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10068 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10069 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10070 to do anything here.
10071 @end deftypefn
10072
10073 @node C++ ABI
10074 @section C++ ABI parameters
10075 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10076
10077 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10078 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10079 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10080 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10081 @end deftypefn
10082
10083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10084 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10085 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10086 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10087 @end deftypefn
10088
10089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10090 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10091 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10092 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10093 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10094 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10095 @end deftypefn
10096
10097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10098 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10099 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10100 @end deftypefn
10101
10102 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10103 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10104 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10105 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10106 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10107 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10108 backend's targeted operating system.
10109 @end deftypefn
10110
10111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10112 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10113 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10114 @code{false}.
10115 @end deftypefn
10116
10117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10118 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10119 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10120 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10121 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10122 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10123 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10124 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10125 @end deftypefn
10126
10127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10128 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10129 @end deftypefn
10130
10131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10132 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10133 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10134 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10135 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10136 unit will not be COMDAT.
10137 @end deftypefn
10138
10139 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10140 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10141 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10142 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10143 @end deftypefn
10144
10145 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10146 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10147 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10148 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10149 @end deftypefn
10150
10151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10152 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10153 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10154 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10155 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10156 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10157 @end deftypefn
10158
10159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10160 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10161 @end deftypefn
10162
10163 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10164 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10165 @end deftypefn
10166
10167 @node Named Address Spaces
10168 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10169 @cindex named address spaces
10170
10171 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10172 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10173 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10174 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10175 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10176 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10177 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10178 @code{const} type attributes.
10179
10180 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10181 pointers to the generic address space.
10182
10183 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10184 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10185 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10186 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10187 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10188 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10189 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10190 always 32 bits).
10191
10192 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10193 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10194 address space.
10195
10196 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10197 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10198 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10199 named address space #1:
10200 @smallexample
10201 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10202 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10203 @end smallexample
10204
10205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10206 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10207 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10208 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10209 generic address space only.
10210 @end deftypefn
10211
10212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10213 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10214 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10215 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10216 generic address space only.
10217 @end deftypefn
10218
10219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10220 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10221 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10222 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10223 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10224 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10225 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10226 target hooks for the given address space.
10227 @end deftypefn
10228
10229 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10230 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10231 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10232 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10233 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10234 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10235 explicit named address space support.
10236 @end deftypefn
10237
10238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10239 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10240 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10241 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10242 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10243 @end deftypefn
10244
10245 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10246 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10247 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10248 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10249 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10250 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10251 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10252 @end deftypefn
10253
10254 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10255 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10256 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10257 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10258 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10259 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10260 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10261 @end deftypefn
10262
10263 @node Misc
10264 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10265 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10266
10267 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10268 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10269
10270 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10271 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10272 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10273 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10274 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10275 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10276 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10277 @end defmac
10278
10279 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10280 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10281 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10282 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10283 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10284 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10285 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10286 @end defmac
10287
10288 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10289 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10290 elements of a jump-table should have.
10291 @end defmac
10292
10293 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10294 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10295 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10296 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10297 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10298 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10299 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10300 flags can be updated.
10301 @end defmac
10302
10303 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10304 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10305 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10306 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10307 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10308 is in effect.
10309 @end defmac
10310
10311 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10312 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10313 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10314 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10315 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10316 @end deftypefn
10317
10318 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10319 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10320 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10321 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10322 @end defmac
10323
10324 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10325 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10326 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10327 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10328 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10329 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10330 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10331 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10332
10333 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10334 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10335 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10336 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10337 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10338
10339 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10340 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10341 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10342 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10343 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10344
10345 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10346 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10347 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10348 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10349 @end defmac
10350
10351 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10352 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10353 extends.
10354 @end defmac
10355
10356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10357 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10358 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10359 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10360 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10361 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10362 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10363 @end deftypefn
10364
10365 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10366 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10367 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10368 @end defmac
10369
10370 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10371 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10372 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10373 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10374 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10375 at run-time.
10376 @end defmac
10377
10378 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10379 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10380 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10381 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10382 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10383 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10384 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10385 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10386 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10387 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10388 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10389
10390 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10391 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10392 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10393
10394 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10395 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10396 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10397 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10398 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10399
10400 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10401 @end defmac
10402
10403 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (enum machine_mode @var{mode})
10405 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10406 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10407 @xref{shift patterns}.
10408
10409 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10410 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10411 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10412 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10413 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10414 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10415
10416 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10417 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10418 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10419
10420 The default implementation of this function returns
10421 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10422 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10423 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10424 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10425 by overriding it.
10426 @end deftypefn
10427
10428 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10429 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10430 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10431 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10432 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10433
10434 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10435
10436 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10437 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10438 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10439 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10440 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10441 such cases may improve things.
10442 @end defmac
10443
10444 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10445 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10446 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10447 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10448 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10449 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10450 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10451 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10452 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10453 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10454 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10455
10456 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10457 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10458 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10459 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10460
10461 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10462 describe two related properties. If you define
10463 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10464 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10465 extension.
10466
10467 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10468 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10469 @code{mode}.
10470 @end deftypefn
10471
10472 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10473 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10474 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10475 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10476 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10477 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10478
10479 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10480 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10481 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10482 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10483 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10484 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10485 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10486 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10487 the compiler.
10488
10489 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10490 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10491 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10492 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10493 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10494 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10495 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10496 expression
10497
10498 @smallexample
10499 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 @noindent
10503 can be converted to
10504
10505 @smallexample
10506 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10507 @end smallexample
10508
10509 @noindent
10510 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10511 tested into the sign bit.
10512
10513 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10514 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10515 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10516 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10517 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10518 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10519
10520 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10521 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10522 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10523 to be used:
10524
10525 @itemize @bullet
10526 @item
10527 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10528 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10529 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10530 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10531 combine the normalization with other operations.
10532
10533 @item
10534 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10535 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10536 other machines.
10537
10538 @item
10539 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10540 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10541 others.
10542
10543 @item
10544 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10545 @end itemize
10546
10547 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10548 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10549 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10550 those cases, e.g., one matching
10551
10552 @smallexample
10553 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10554 @end smallexample
10555
10556 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10557 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10558 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10559 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10560 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10561 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10562 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10563 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10564
10565 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10566 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10567 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10568 @end defmac
10569
10570 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10571 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10572 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10573 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10574 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10575 this macro.
10576 @end defmac
10577
10578 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10579 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10580 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10581 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10582 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10583 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10584 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10585 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10586 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10587 given mode.
10588 @end defmac
10589
10590 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10591 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10592 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10593 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10594 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10595 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10596 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10597 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10598 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10599 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10600 this value.
10601
10602 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10603 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10604
10605 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10606 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10607 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10608 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10609
10610 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10611 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10612 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10613 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10614 breaking the API@.
10615 @end defmac
10616
10617 @defmac Pmode
10618 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10619 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10620 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10621 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10622 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10623
10624 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10625 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10626 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10627 to @code{Pmode}.
10628 @end defmac
10629
10630 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10631 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10632 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10633 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10634 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10635 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10636 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10637 @end defmac
10638
10639 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10640 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10641 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10642 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10643 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10644 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10645
10646 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10647 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10648 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10649 @end defmac
10650
10651 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10652 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10653
10654 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10655 @end deftypefn
10656
10657 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10658 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10659 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10660 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10661 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10662 @end defmac
10663
10664 @findex #pragma
10665 @findex pragma
10666 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10667 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10668 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10669 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10670 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10671 setup required for the pragmas.
10672
10673 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10674 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10675 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10676
10677 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10678 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10679
10680 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10681 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10682 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10683 @end defmac
10684
10685 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10686 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10687
10688 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10689 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10690 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10691 pragma of the form
10692
10693 @smallexample
10694 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10695 @end smallexample
10696
10697 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10698 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10699 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10700 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10701 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10702 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10703 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10704 arguments of pragmas registered with
10705 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10706 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10707
10708 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10709 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10710 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10711 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10712 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10713 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10714 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10715 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10716 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10717 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10718 how to build this object file.
10719 @end deftypefun
10720
10721 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10722 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10723 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10724 @end defmac
10725
10726 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10727 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10728 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10729 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10730 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10731 @end defmac
10732
10733 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10734 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10735 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10736 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10737 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10738 @end defmac
10739
10740 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10741 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10742 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10743 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10744 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10745 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10746 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10747 you should define this macro.
10748
10749 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10750 @end defmac
10751
10752 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10753 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10754 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10755 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10756 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10757 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10758 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10759 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10760 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10761 slot of @var{insn}.
10762
10763 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10764 @end defmac
10765
10766 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10767 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10768 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10769 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10770 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10771 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10772
10773 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10774 @end defmac
10775
10776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (tree @var{outputs}, tree @var{inputs}, tree @var{clobbers})
10777 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10778 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10779 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10780 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10781 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10782 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10783 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10784 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10785 @end deftypefn
10786
10787 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10788 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10789 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10790 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10791 separate math library.
10792
10793 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10794 @end defmac
10795
10796 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10797 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10798 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10799
10800 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10801 is wrong.
10802 @end defmac
10803
10804 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10805 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10806 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10807 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10808 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10809 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10810 for cross-profiling.
10811 @end defmac
10812
10813 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10814
10815 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10816 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10817 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10818 1 if it does use cc0.
10819 @end defmac
10820
10821 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10822 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10823 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10824 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10825 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10826 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10827 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10828 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10829 @end defmac
10830
10831 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10832 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10833 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10834 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10835 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10836 @end defmac
10837
10838 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10839 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10840 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10841 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10842 about the currently processed blocks.
10843 @end defmac
10844
10845 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10846 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10847 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10848 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10849 to by @var{ce_info}.
10850 @end defmac
10851
10852 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10853 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10854 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10855 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10856 to by @var{ce_info}.
10857 @end defmac
10858
10859 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10860 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10861 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10862 to by @var{ce_info}.
10863 @end defmac
10864
10865 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10866 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10867 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10868 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10869
10870 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10871 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10872 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10873 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10874
10875 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10876 definition is null.
10877 @end deftypefn
10878
10879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10880 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10881 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10882 necessary setup.
10883
10884 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10885 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10886 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10887 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10888
10889 To create a built-in function, call the function
10890 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10891 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10892 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10893 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10894 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10895 @end deftypefn
10896
10897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10898 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10899 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10900 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10901 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10902 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10903 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10904 @code{error_mark_node}.
10905 @end deftypefn
10906
10907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10908
10909 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10910 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10911 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10912 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10913 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10914 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10915 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10916 built-in function.
10917 @end deftypefn
10918
10919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10920 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10921 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10922 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10923 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10924 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10925 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10926 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10927 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10928 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10929 @end deftypefn
10930
10931 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10932 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10933 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10934 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10935 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10936 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10937 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10938 @end deftypefn
10939
10940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10941 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
10942 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
10943 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
10944 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
10945 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
10946 the two function decls that will be compared.
10947 @end deftypefn
10948
10949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
10950 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
10951 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
10952 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
10953 identical versions.
10954 @end deftypefn
10955
10956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
10957 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
10958 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
10959 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
10960 body must be generated.
10961 @end deftypefn
10962
10963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const_rtx @var{insn})
10964
10965 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10966 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10967 could not be applied.
10968
10969 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10970 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10971 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10972 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10973 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10974 @end deftypefn
10975
10976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx @var{insn})
10977 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
10978 @end deftypefn
10979
10980 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10981
10982 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10983 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10984 @var{branch2} is possible.
10985
10986 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10987 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10988 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10989 @end defmac
10990
10991 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const_rtx @var{follower}, const_rtx @var{followee})
10992 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
10993 @end deftypefn
10994
10995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
10996 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10997 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10998 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10999 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11000 @end deftypefn
11001
11002 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11003
11004 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11005 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11006 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11007 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11008 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11009 that had its initial value copied by using
11010 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11011 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11012 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11013 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11014 @code{MEM}.
11015 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11016 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11017 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11018 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11019 register in question will not be clobbered.
11020 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11021 allocation.
11022 @end deftypefn
11023
11024 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11025 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11026 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11027 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11028 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11029 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11030 passed along.
11031 @end deftypefn
11032
11033 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11034 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11035 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11036 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11037 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11038 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11039 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11040 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11041 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11042 The default hook function does nothing.
11043
11044 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11045 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11046 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11047 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11048 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11049 outside of any function scope.
11050 @end deftypefn
11051
11052 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11053 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11054 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11055 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11056 @end defmac
11057
11058 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11059 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11060 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11061 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11062 executable files.
11063 @end defmac
11064
11065 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11066 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11067 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11068 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11069 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11070 lists.
11071 @end defmac
11072
11073 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11074 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11075 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11076 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11077 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11078 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11079 defined as this expression:
11080
11081 @smallexample
11082 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11083 build_tree_list
11084 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11085 NULL))
11086 @end smallexample
11087 @end defmac
11088
11089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11090 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11091 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11092 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11093 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11094
11095 @smallexample
11096 static bool
11097 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11098 @{
11099 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11100 @}
11101 @end smallexample
11102 @end deftypefn
11103
11104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11105 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11106 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11107 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11108 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11109 to inter-block scheduling.
11110 @end deftypefn
11111
11112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11113 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11114 registers
11115 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11116 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11117 that all target registers in the class returned by
11118 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11119 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11120 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11121 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11122 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11123 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11124 @end deftypefn
11125
11126 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11127 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11128 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11129 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11130 @end deftypefn
11131
11132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11133 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11134 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11135 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11136 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11137 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11138 number of memory accesses.
11139 @end deftypefn
11140
11141 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11142 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11143 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11144 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11145 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11146 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11147 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11148 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11149 @end defmac
11150
11151 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11152 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11153 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11154 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11155 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11156 @end deftypefn
11157
11158 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11159 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11160 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11161 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11162 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11163 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11164 @end deftypefn
11165
11166 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11167 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11168 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11169 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11170 that are different from @option{-I}.
11171 @end deftypefn
11172
11173 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11174 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11175 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11176 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11177 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11178 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11179 @end defmac
11180
11181 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11182 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11183 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11184 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11185 @end defmac
11186
11187 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11188 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11189 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11190 @end defmac
11191
11192 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11193 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11194 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11195 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11196 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11197 @end defmac
11198
11199 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11200 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11201 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11202 @end defmac
11203
11204 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11205 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11206 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11207 and scanf formatter settings.
11208 @end defmac
11209
11210 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11211 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11212 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11213 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11214 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11215 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11216 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11217 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11218 @end deftypevr
11219
11220 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11221 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11222 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11223 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11224 @end deftypefn
11225
11226 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11227 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11228 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11229 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11230 @end deftypefn
11231
11232 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11233 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11234 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11235 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11236 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11237 @end deftypefn
11238
11239 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11240 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11241 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11242 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11243 the front end.
11244 @end deftypefn
11245
11246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11247 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11248 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11249 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11250 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11251 @end deftypefn
11252
11253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11254 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11255 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11256 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11257 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11258 @end deftypefn
11259
11260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11261 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11262 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11263 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11264 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11265 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11266 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11267 @end deftypefn
11268
11269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11270 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11271 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11272 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11273 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11274 conversion rules.
11275 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11276 @end deftypefn
11277
11278 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11279 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11280 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11281 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11282 @end defmac
11283
11284 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11285 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11286 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11287 @end defmac
11288
11289 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11290 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11291 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11292 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11293 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11294 @end defmac
11295
11296 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11297 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11298 necessary.
11299 @end deftypefn
11300
11301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11302 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11303 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11304 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11305 is needed.
11306 @end deftypefn
11307
11308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11309 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11310 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11311 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11312 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11313 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11314 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11315 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11316 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11317 @end deftypefn
11318
11319 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11320 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11321 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11322 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11323 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11324 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11325 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11326 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11327 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11328 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11329 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11330 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11331 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11332 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11333 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11334 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11335 @end deftypevr
11336
11337 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11338 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11339 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11340 supported by the target.
11341 @end deftypefn
11342
11343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11344 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11345 memory model bits are allowed.
11346 @end deftypefn
11347
11348 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11349 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11350 @end deftypevr